Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
AV Surround Receiver
SR7008
You can print more than one page of a PDF onto a single sheet of paper.
Owner’s Manual
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Contents
Connecting a playback device···················································· 43
Accessories························································································· 7
Connecting a set-top box (Satellite tuner/cable TV)························ 44
Connecting a DVD player································································ 45
Connecting a video camcorder or other device······························· 46
Connecting a turntable···································································· 47
Connecting a device with a multi-channel output connector·········· 48
Inserting the batteries······································································· 8
Operating range of the remote control unit······································ 8
Features······························································································· 9
High quality sound············································································· 9
High performance··········································································· 10
Easy operation················································································· 11
Connecting an iPod or USB memory device
to the USB port··············································································· 49
Connecting an HD Radio receiver·············································· 51
Connecting to a home network (LAN)····································· 53
Connecting a wireless receiver (RX101)·································· 55
Connecting an external control device···································· 56
Part names and functions
Front panel······················································································· 12
With the door open········································································· 14
Main Display···················································································· 17
Sub Display······················································································ 19
Rear panel························································································· 21
Remote control unit······································································· 24
Remotely connecting Marantz devices··········································· 56
Remotely control a Marantz Blu-ray Disc player
by the Marantz Remote App··························································· 57
DC OUT jack···················································································· 57
Connecting the power cord························································· 58
Connections
Playback
Speaker connection······································································· 29
Speaker installation········································································· 29
Speaker connection········································································· 32
Connecting a TV············································································· 39
Connection 1 : TV equipped with an HDMI connector
and compatible with the ARC (Audio Return Channel)··················· 40
Connection 2 : TV equipped with an HDMI connector···················· 41
Connection 3 : TV equipped without an HDMI connector·············· 42
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Basic operation··············································································· 60
Turning the power on······································································ 60
Selecting the input source······························································ 60
Adjusting the master volume·························································· 61
Turning off the sound temporarily··················································· 61
Playing a DVD player/Blu-ray Disc player········································ 61
2
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Playing an iPod················································································ 62
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Viewing photographs on the Flickr site·································· 87
Listening to music on an iPod························································· 63
iPod Browse Mode Settings··························································· 64
Performing repeat playback···························································· 66
Performing random playback·························································· 66
Playing a USB memory device··················································· 67
Playing files stored on USB memory devices································· 68
Listening to HD Radio™ stations·············································· 70
Listening to HD Radio broadcasts··················································· 71
Tuning in by entering the frequency (Direct Tune)·························· 73
Changing the tuning mode (Tune Mode)········································ 73
Selecting audio programs································································ 74
Listening to preset stations····························································· 74
Presetting the current broadcast station (Preset Memory)············· 75
Tuning in to stations and presetting them automatically
(Auto Preset Memory)····································································· 76
Specify a name for the preset broadcast station (Preset Name)···· 76
Skipping preset broadcast stations (Preset Skip)···························· 77
Cancelling preset skip····································································· 77
Check the HD Radio reception information····································· 78
Listening to Internet Radio·························································· 79
Listening to Internet Radio······························································ 80
Playing the last played Internet Radio station································· 81
Using vTuner to add Internet Radio stations to favorites················ 82
Playing back files stored on a PC and NAS···························· 83
Applying media sharing settings····················································· 84
Playing back files stored on a PC and NAS····································· 85
Front panel
Tips
Viewing photographs shared by particular users···························· 88
Viewing all photographs on Flickr···················································· 90
Listening to Pandora®·································································· 91
Listening to Pandora®······································································ 92
Creating a new station···································································· 93
Listening to an existing station······················································· 95
Listening to created radio stations at random································· 95
Giving Feedback and Managing Stations········································ 96
Sign Out·························································································· 97
Listening to SiriusXM Internet Radio······································· 98
Listening to SiriusXM Internet Radio·············································· 98
Sign Out························································································ 100
Listening to Spotify····································································· 101
Listening to Spotify······································································· 101
Adding to the FAVORITE STATION button·························· 105
Playing back content added
to the FAVORITE STATION button··············································· 106
AirPlay function············································································ 107
Playing songs from your iPhone, iPod touch or iPad ···················· 107
Playing iTunes music with this unit··············································· 108
Selecting multiple speakers (devices)··········································· 108
Perform iTunes playback operations
with the remote control unit of this unit······································· 109
3
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Convenience functions······························································· 110
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
InstaPrevue function··································································· 133
Performing repeat playback·························································· 111
Performing random playback························································ 111
Registering to Favorites································································ 112
Playing back content added in “Save to Favorites”······················ 112
Deleting content added to favorites ············································· 113
Searching content with keywords (Text Search)··························· 113
Playing back music and a favorite picture at the same time
(Slideshow)···················································································· 114
Setting the Slideshow Interval······················································ 115
Displaying your desired video during audio playback
(Video Select)················································································ 115
Adjusting the picture quality for your viewing environment
(Picture Mode)··············································································· 116
Playing the Same Music in All Zones (All Zone Stereo)················ 117
Selecting a sound mode····························································· 118
Selecting a sound mode································································ 119
Direct playback·············································································· 120
Pure Direct playback····································································· 120
Auto surround playback································································· 121
HDMI control function································································· 132
Setting procedure·········································································· 132
Front panel
Tips
Switching input sources································································ 134
Setting how to display sub screens·············································· 134
Changing the display location of sub screens······························· 134
Sleep timer function···································································· 135
Using the sleep timer···································································· 135
Rec out function············································································ 136
Recording on an External Device·················································· 137
Web control function··································································· 138
Controlling the unit from a web control········································ 138
Dual backup memory function················································· 140
Remembering set details (Backup)··············································· 140
Recalling remembered details (Recovery)····································· 140
Panel lock function······································································· 141
Disabling all key button operations··············································· 141
Disabling all button operations except VOLUME·························· 141
Canceling the Panel lock function················································· 142
Remote lock function·································································· 143
Disabling the sensor function of the remote control unit·············· 143
Enabling the remote sensor function············································ 143
Switches light illumination on/off·········································· 144
Playback in ZONE2/ZONE3 (Separate room)······················· 145
Connecting ZONE········································································· 145
Playback in ZONE·········································································· 149
4
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Audyssey® Setup········································································· 183
Settings
Procedure for speaker settings (Audyssey® Setup)······················· 185
Error messages············································································· 190
Retrieving Audyssey® Setup settings············································ 191
Manual Setup················································································ 192
Amp Assign··················································································· 192
Speaker Config.············································································· 193
Distances······················································································ 195
Levels···························································································· 196
Crossovers···················································································· 197
Bass······························································································ 198
Impedance···················································································· 198
Front Speaker················································································ 198
Network·························································································· 199
Information···················································································· 199
IP Control······················································································ 199
Friendly Name··············································································· 199
Settings························································································· 200
Diagnostics···················································································· 201
Maintenance Mode······································································· 202
General···························································································· 203
Language······················································································· 203
ZONE2 Setup / ZONE3 Setup······················································· 203
Zone Rename················································································ 205
Trigger Out 1 / Trigger Out 2························································· 205
Auto Standby················································································· 206
Front Display················································································· 206
Information···················································································· 207
Usage Data···················································································· 208
Firmware······················································································· 209
Setup Lock···················································································· 211
Menu map······················································································· 151
Menu operation············································································· 158
Inputting characters···································································· 159
Using the keyboard screen··························································· 160
Using the number buttons···························································· 160
Audio································································································ 161
Dialog Level··················································································· 161
Subwoofer Level··········································································· 161
Surround Parameter······································································ 162
Tone······························································································ 165
M-DAX··························································································· 165
Audio Delay··················································································· 166
Volume·························································································· 166
Audyssey······················································································· 167
Graphic EQ···················································································· 171
Video································································································ 172
Picture Adjust················································································ 172
HDMI Setup·················································································· 173
Output Settings············································································· 175
Component Video Out·································································· 177
On Screen Display········································································· 178
TV Format······················································································ 178
Inputs······························································································· 179
Input Assign·················································································· 179
Source Rename············································································· 181
Hide Sources················································································· 181
Source Level················································································· 181
Input Select··················································································· 182
Speakers························································································· 183
Front panel
Tips
Display
Rear panel
5
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
About HDMI····················································································· 242
Video conversion function····························································· 245
Playing back USB memory devices············································· 247
Playing back files stored on PC or NAS······································ 248
Playing back Internet Radio·························································· 249
Personal memory plus function··················································· 249
Last function memory···································································· 249
Sound modes and channel output··············································· 250
Sound modes and surround parameters···································· 251
Types of input signals, and corresponding sound modes······· 254
Explanation of terms······································································ 257
Trademark information··································································· 264
Specifications·················································································· 266
Index································································································· 269
License····························································································· 272
List of preset codes······································································· 279
Registering preset codes······························································ 213
Operating devices········································································· 216
Check the registered preset code················································· 219
Initializing registered preset codes················································ 219
Operating learn function···························································· 220
Remembering remote control codes from other devices············· 220
Delete saved remote control codes·············································· 221
Setting the back light·································································· 223
Disabling the backlight·································································· 223
Turning the backlight on································································ 223
Specifying the zone used
with the remote control unit···················································· 224
Tips
Contents·························································································· 225
Tips································································································ 226
Troubleshooting············································································ 228
Resetting factory settings·························································· 241
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Appendix
Operating external devices
with the remote control unit···················································· 212
Front panel
Tips
AVR······························································································· 279
TV group························································································ 279
DVD group····················································································· 281
CD group······················································································· 282
CBL/SAT group·············································································· 283
Blu-ray group················································································· 284
6
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
Thank you for purchasing this Marantz product. To ensure proper operation, please read this owner’s manual carefully before using the product.
After reading this manual, be sure to keep it for future reference.
Accessories
Check that the following parts are supplied with the product.
qGetting Started
wCD-ROM (Owner’s Manual)
eSafety Instructions
rWarranty
tPower cord
yRemote control unit (RC023SR)
uR03/AAA batteries
iAM loop antenna
oFM indoor antenna
Q0Setup and measurement
Q1Cable label
Front panel
microphone (ACM1HB)
Display
Rear panel
7
Remote
(for USA)
(for CANADA)
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Inserting the batteries
Operating range of the remote control
unit
q Slide the rear cover off the remote control
unit in the arrow direction.
w Load the two batteries properly as
indicated by the q and w marks in the
battery compartment.
Point the remote control unit at the remote sensor when operating it.
Approx. 23 ft/7 m
R03/AAA
e Put the rear cover back on.
NOTE
•When inserting the batteries, be sure to do so in the proper direction, following the
q and w marks in the battery compartment.
•To prevent damage or leakage of battery fluid:
•Do not use a new battery together with an old one.
•Do not use two different types of batteries.
•Remove the batteries from the remote control unit if it will not be in use for long
periods.
•If the battery fluid should leak, carefully wipe the fluid off the inside of the battery
compartment and insert new batteries.
Front panel
Display
Appendix
Tips
Rear panel
8
Remote
Index
30° 30°
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Features
•Audyssey LFC™ (Low Frequency Containment) (vpage 169)
Audyssey LFC™ solves the problem of low frequency sounds disturbing
people in neighboring rooms or apartments. Audyssey LFC™ dynamically
monitors the audio content and removes the low frequencies that
pass through walls, floors and ceilings. It then applies psychoacoustic
processing to restore the perception of low bass for listeners in the
room. The result is great sound that no longer disturbs the neighbors.
High quality sound
•With discrete circuit technology, the power amplifier provides
identical quality for all 9-channels (165 Watts x 9-channels)
For optimum realism and stunning dynamic range, the power amplifier
section features discrete power devices (not integrated circuitry).
By using high current, high power discrete power devices, the amplifier
is able to easily drive high quality speakers.
•Discrete subwoofers and Audyssey Sub EQ HT™ (vpage 184)
The unit has two subwoofer output capability and can adjust the level
and delay for each subwoofer individually.
Audyssey Sub EQ HT™ makes the integration seamless by first
compensating for any level and delay differences between the two
subwoofers and then applying Audyssey MultEQ® XT32 to both
subwoofers together for improved deep bass response and detail.
•Current feedback amplifier
This unit uses a high-speed current feedback amplifier circuit for
its preamplifier so that signals from a Blu-ray Disc player and other
equipment that support high-definition audio formats can be amplified
with high fidelity. The high-speed current feedback amplifier also
reproduces a natural sound space.
•DTS Neo:X (vpage 118)
This technology enables the playback of 2-channel source audio or
7.1/5.1 multi-channel source audio through a maximum 9.1-channel
speakers, achieving an even broader soundstage.
•Audyssey DSX® (vpage 170)
This unit is equipped with Audyssey DSX® processor. By connecting
front height speakers to this unit and playing back with Audyssey
DSX® processing you can experience a more vertically expansive front
soundstage. By connecting two front wide speakers, you can experience
a wider and more expanded front soundstage.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
9
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
•Equipped with Hybrid PLL Jitter Reducer capable of reducing jitter
and phase noise that negatively affects sound quality
Marantz’s Hybrid Phase Lock Loop Jitter Reducer improves sound
localization, reproducing a broad and natural soundstage.
Tips
Appendix
•Supports Internet Radio, music, and photograph streaming
Supports AirPlay® (vpage 107)
You can enjoy a wide variety of content, including listening to Internet
Radio, playing audio files stored on your PC, and displaying photographs
stored on your PC on our television.
This unit also supports Apple AirPlay which lets you stream your music
library from an iPhone®, iPad®, iPod touch® or iTunes®.
High performance
•Digital video processor upscales analog video signals (SD resolution)
to HD (720p/1080p) and 4K (vpage 242)
This unit features a sophisticated video processor that can upscale
standard definition (SD) analog video content from legacy sources such
as a VCR to HD and is able to output at 4K Ultra HD resolution (3840 x
2160 pixels) for compatibility with newly available high resolution 4K TVs.
•Equipped with HDMI ZONE2 output (vpage 145)
The ZONE2 multi-room output includes an HDMI output that lets you
enjoy a different A/V source in that room, with another program playing
in the main room.
•Compatible with “Marantz Remote App” for performing basic
operations of the unit with an iPad, iPhone or Androidz smartphone
“Marantz Remote App” is application software that allows you to
perform basic operations with an iPad, iPhone, Android smartphone or
Android tablet such as turning the unit ON/OFF, controlling the volume,
and switching the source.
zz Download the appropriate “Marantz Remote App” for iOS and
Android devices. This unit needs to be connected to your LAN and
the iPhone/iPod touch or other device needs to be connected to the
same network by Wi-Fi (wireless LAN).
•Simultaneous playback via two HDMI outputs (for MAIN ZONE)
(vpage 145)
This unit is equipped with two HDMI MONITOR outputs. You can
connect one output to a projector and the other output to a TV for
simultaneous signal outputs.
•HDMI connections enable quick connection to various digital AV
devices (7 inputs, 3 outputs)
This unit is equipped with 7 HDMI inputs and 3 HDMI outputs enabling
connection to various HDMI compatible devices such as Blu-ray Disc
players, game consoles, HD video camcorders and HD TVs.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
10
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
•Supports HDMI (3D, ARC, Deep Color, “x.v.Color”, Auto Lip Sync,
4K) and HDMI control function (vpage 242)
Advanced HDMI features are supported, including 3D passthrough,
Audio Return Channel, Auto Lip Sync, Deep Color and “x.v.Color”, and
HDMI CEC control functions. If a 4K digital video signal is input, it is
passed through the unit unchanged, and the GUI overlay will adjust the
resolution accordingly.
Tips
•M-XPort (Marantz-eXtension Port) (vpage 55)
This unit is equipped with the M-XPort, a Marantz original innovation
that provides outstanding expandability. You can connect the Wireless
Receiver RX101 (sold separately) to this port.
Easy operation
•“Setup Assistant” provides easy-to-follow setup instructions
First select the language when prompted. Then simply follow the
instructions displayed on the TV screen to set up the speakers, network,
etc.
•Direct play for iPod and iPhone via USB (vpage 49)
Music data from an iPod or iPhone can be played back if you connect
the USB cable supplied with the iPod via the USB port of this unit, and
also an iPod and iPhone can be controlled with the remote control that
comes with this unit.
•Easy to use Graphical User Interface
This unit is equipped with an easy to see Graphical User Interface that
uses menu displays and features colorful icons and easy to understand
controls for maximum ease of use.
•Equipped with 3 source 3 zone Multi-Zone Function
Lets you enjoy audio and video in the main room, and have up to
1 other zones with different audio content delivered to each room
(vpage 145).
•Multi-Room audio
Enjoy the same music in your home theater and another room at the
same time (vpage 117).
•InstaPrevue Technology (vpage 133)
Live picture-in-picture preview of HDMI sources that are connected to
the unit.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
11
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Part names and functions
Front panel
u
y
q
Front panel
w
Display
t
r
e
Rear panel
12
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
u
y t
qw
Playback
Settings
Appendix
eDoor
r
When you are using buttons and/or connectors behind the door, press
the bottom of the door to open it. Be careful not to catch your fingers
when closing the door.
e
rVOLUME knob
qPower operation button (X)
This adjusts the volume level (vpage 61).
This turns the power of MAIN ZONE on/off (standby) (vpage 60).
tRemote control sensor
wPower indicator
This receives signals from the remote control unit (vpage 8).
This is lit as follows according to the power status:
•Power on : Off
•Normal standby : Red
•When “HDMI Pass Through” (vpage 174) or “HDMI Control”
(vpage 174) is set to “On” : Orange
•When “IP Control” (vpage 199) is set to “Always On” : Orange
Front panel
Tips
Display
Rear panel
yMain Display
This displays various pieces of information (vpage 17).
uINPUT SELECTOR knob
This selects the input source (vpage 60).
13
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
With the door open
Tips
Appendix
wSETUP MIC jack
i
o
Used to connect the supplied Setup and measurement microphone
(vpage 186).
uy
eUSB port
Used to connect USB storages (such as USB memory devices) and the
USB cable supplied with iPod (vpage 49).
rHDMI 7 (AUX 1) connector
Used to connect HDMI output compatible devices such as video
camcorders and game consoles (vpage 46).
tAUX 1 INPUT connectors
q
w
e
r
Used to connect analog output compatible devices such as video
camcorders and game consoles (vpage 46).
t
ySETUP button
This displays the menu on the TV screen (vpage 158).
uENTER button
This determines the selection (vpage 158).
iCursor buttons (uio p)
These select items (vpage 158).
oBACK button
qHeadphones jack (PHONES)
This returns to the previous screen (vpage 158).
Used to connect headphones.
When the headphones are plugged into this jack, audio will no longer be
output from the connected speakers or from the PRE OUT connectors.
NOTE
•To prevent hearing loss, do not raise the volume level excessively when using
headphones.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
14
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Q2M-DAX button/indicator
Q2 Q1
Q4 Q3
This enables the M-DAX mode (vpage 165).
This lights when the M-DAX mode is selected.
Q0
Q3PURE DIRECT button/indicator
This switches the sound mode between DIRECT, PURE DIRECT and
AUTO (vpage 120, 121).
This lights when the PURE DIRECT mode is selected as the sound
mode.
Q5
Q6
Q4DYNAMIC EQ button
Q7
This switches the Dynamic EQ settings (vpage 168).
Q5MOVIE button
This switches the sound mode to “MOVIE” (vpage 119).
Q6MUSIC button
This switches the sound mode to “MUSIC” (vpage 119).
Q7GAME button
This switches the sound mode to “GAME” (vpage 119).
Q0Sub display
This displays various pieces of information (vpage 19).
Q1Dynamic Volume button (DYNAMIC VOL)
This switches the Dynamic Volume settings (vpage 169).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
15
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
W0HDMI OUT button
This sets the HDMI monitor output (vpage 174).
W1DISPLAY button
This switches the display mode of the display (vpage 144, 206).
W2STATUS button
Q8 Q9
W0 W1 W2 W3 W4
Each press of this switches the status information that is shown on the
display (vpage 64).
W5
W3ZONE SELECT button
These switch the zone (MAIN ZONE, ZONE2, ZONE3) that is operated
through the remote control unit (vpage 149, 158).
W4ZONE2 ON/OFF button
This turns the power of ZONE2 on/off (vpage 149).
W5ZONE3 ON/OFF button
This turns the power of ZONE3 on/off (vpage 149).
Q8Audyssey DSX® button (A-DSX)
This switches the Audyssey DSX® settings (vpage 170).
Q9Speaker A/B switching button (SPKR A/B)
This sets the front speakers to use (vpage 198).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
16
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Main Display
The input source name, sound mode, setting values and other information are displayed here.
22Standard display
22Tuner display
These light according to the reception conditions when the input
source is set to “HD Radio”.
r t
q
w
e
rLights up when the broadcast is properly turned in.
tIn the FM mode, this lights up when receiving stereo broadcasts.
qLight illumination
When the power to this device is switched on, the surrounding area is
lit blue. The settings can be changed so the light does not switch on
(vpage 144 “Switches light illumination on/off”).
wMaster volume indicator
eInput source indicator
The currently selected input source name is displayed.
If the input source name has been changed using “Source Rename”
(vpage 181) in the menu, the input source name after the change
is displayed.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
17
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Sleep timer display
Appendix
Tips
22ZONE2/ZONE3 power on display
u i
y
uThis lights up when ZONE2 (separate room) power is turned on
yThis lights when the sleep mode is selected (vpage 135).
(vpage 149).
iThis lights up when ZONE3 (separate room) power is turned on
(vpage 149).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
18
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
Sub Display
Q2
Q1
Q0
o
i
u
q
w
qInformation display
The channel for input/output signals is displayed according to the
setting configured for “Channel Indicators” (vpage 206).
•When “Channel Indicators” is set to “Output” (Default)
These light when audio signals are being output from the speakers.
•When “Channel Indicators” is set to “Input”
These light corresponding to the channels that include the input
signals.
When playing HD Audio sources, the
indicator lights when a
signal from an extension channel (a channel other than the front,
center, surround, surround back, front height, front wide or LFE
channel) is input.
wFront speaker indicator
This lights according to the setting of the front A and B speakers.
Display
Rear panel
e
eInput/output signal channel indicators
The input source name, sound mode, setting values and other
information are displayed here.
Front panel
yt r
19
Remote
Index
Contents
Q2
Connections
Q1
Q0
o
Playback
i u
Settings
Tips
oTuner reception mode indicators
ytr
These light according to the reception conditions when the input
source is set to “HD Radio”.
STEREO : In FM mode, this lights up when receiving stereo broadcasts.
TUNED : Lights up when the broadcast is properly tuned in.
Q0Audyssey® indicator
This indicator lights when the “MultEQ® XT32” (vpage 167),
“Dynamic EQ” (vpage 168) or “Dynamic Volume” (vpage 169)
setting is set to other than “Off” and “Audyssey LFC™” (vpage 169)
setting or “Audyssey DSX®” (vpage 170) is set to other than “Off”.
rMaster volume indicator
tMUTE indicator
Q1Decoder indicator
ySleep timer indicator
Q2Input signal indicators
These light when Dolby or DTS signals are input or when the Dolby or
DTS decoder is running.
This blinks while the sound is muted (vpage 61, 150).
This lights when the sleep mode is selected (vpage 135).
The respective indicator will light corresponding to the input signal
(vpage 182).
uMULTI ZONE indicator
This lights up when ZONE2 or ZONE3 (separate room) power is turned
on (vpage 149).
iMonitor output indicator
These light according to the HDMI monitor output setting.
When set to “Auto(Dual)”, the indicators light according to connection
status (vpage 174).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
20
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
Rear panel
Q7 Q6 Q5
Q4 Q3
Q2
Q1 Q0 oi u
HDMI IN
DIGITAL AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
1 TV AUDIO
2 CD
NETWORK
t
y
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
HDMI OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
r
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
ZONE2
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
ARC
AC IN
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
1
2
COMPONENT VIDEO IN
1 CBL/SAT
PB/
CB
Y
PR /
CR
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
PB/
CB
Y
P R/
CR
IN
DC12V 150mA MAX.
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC OUT
RS-232C
AUDIO IN
1 CBL/SAT
(ASSIGNABLE) VIDEO OUT
VIDEO IN
MEDIA
1 CBL/ 3 MEDIA
PLAYER
SAT
PLAYER
2 DVD
SIGNAL
GND
MEDIA
3 Blu-ray 4 PLAYER
FLASHER
M-XPort
AUDIO IN
(ASSIGNABLE)
5 CD
PHONO
OUT
2 DVD
MONITOR
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
ZONE2
MONITOR/ZONE2
2 DVD
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
AUDIO OUT
7.1CH IN
SURROUND
BACK
MEDIA
PLAYER
PRE OUT
ZONE2
ZONE3
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
BACK
SURROUND
FRONT
HEIGHT
FRONT
WIDE
AM
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER1
SUBWOOFER2
ASSIGNABLE
FM
(75Ω)
ASSIGNABLE
ANTENNA
q
Front panel
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 6~8Ω
SPEAKERS
w
Display
Rear panel
21
CLASS 2 WIRING
e
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Q1 Q0 oi
1 CBL/SAT
t
y
HDMI IN
DIGITAL AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
1 TV AUDIO
2 CD
NETWORK
u
Playback
2 DVD
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
ZONE2
MONITOR1
Used to connect devices
(vpage 40, 41, 44, 45).
MONITOR2
ARC
Appendix
Tips
yHDMI connectors
r
HDMI OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
Settings
equipped
with
HDMI
connectors
equipped
with
video
connectors
AC IN
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
1
2
DC12V 150mA MAX.
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC OUT
RS-232C
AUDIO IN
1 CBL/SAT
(ASSIGNABLE) VIDEO OUT
VIDEO IN
MEDIA
CBL/
MEDIA
1 SAT 3 PLAYER
PLAYER
COMPONENT VIDEO IN
1 CBL/SAT
PB/
CB
Y
PR/
CR
uVideo connectors (VIDEO)
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
PB/
CB
Y
PR/
CR
Used to connect devices
(vpage 42, 44, 45).
IN
2 DVD
SIGNAL
GND
FLASHER
M-XPort
AUDIO IN
(ASSIGNABLE)
MEDIA
3 Blu-ray 4 PLAYER
OUT
5 CD
PHONO
2 DVD
MONITOR
CENTER
SURROUND
MONITOR/ZONE2
2 DVD
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
AUDIO OUT
7.1CH IN
FRONT
ZONE2
SURROUND
BACK
MEDIA
PLAYER
PRE OUT
ZONE2
ZONE3
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND
BACK
FRONT
HEIGHT
FRONT
WIDE
iREMOTE CONTROL connectors
AM
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER1
SUBWOOFER2
Used to connect infrared receivers/transmitters in order to operate this
unit and external devices from a different room (vpage 56).
ASSIGNABLE
FM
(75Ω)
ASSIGNABLE
ANTENNA
q
SPEAKERS
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 6~8Ω
o7.1ch input connectors (7.1CH IN)
CLASS 2 WIRING
w
Used to connect to a device that has multi-channel audio output
connectors (vpage 48).
e
Q0M-XPort connector
qFM/AM antenna terminals (ANTENNA)
Used to connect to a wireless receiver (RX101, sold separately)
(vpage 55).
Used to connect FM and AM antennas (vpage 51).
wSpeaker terminals (SPEAKERS)
Q1FLASHER IN jack
Used to connect speakers (vpage 32).
Used when using a control BOX or other such control devices to
control this unit.
ePRE OUT connectors
Used to connect a subwoofer with a built-in amplifier or an external
power amplifier (vpage 33, 38, 148).
rAC inlet (AC IN)
Used to connect the power cord (vpage 58).
tComponent video connectors (COMPONENT VIDEO)
Used to connect devices equipped with component video connectors
(vpage 42, 44, 45).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
22
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
HDMI IN
DIGITAL AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
1 TV AUDIO
2 CD
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
3 Blu-ray
Used to connect devices equipped with the trigger function
(vpage 57).
HDMI OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
ZONE2
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
ARC
AC IN
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
1
2
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC OUT
RS-232C
AUDIO IN
1 CBL/SAT
(ASSIGNABLE) VIDEO OUT
VIDEO IN
MEDIA
CBL/
MEDIA
1 SAT 3 PLAYER
PLAYER
COMPONENT VIDEO IN
1 CBL/SAT
Y
PB/
CB
PR/
CR
Q7Analog audio connectors (AUDIO)
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
PB/
CB
Y
PR/
CR
Used to connect devices equipped with analog audio connectors
(vpage 44, 45, 47).
IN
DC12V 150mA MAX.
2 DVD
SIGNAL
GND
FLASHER
M-XPort
AUDIO IN
(ASSIGNABLE)
MEDIA
3 Blu-ray 4 PLAYER
5 CD
PHONO
OUT
2 DVD
MONITOR
CENTER
ZONE2
MONITOR/ZONE2
2 DVD
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
AUDIO OUT
7.1CH IN
FRONT
SURROUND
SURROUND
BACK
MEDIA
PLAYER
PRE OUT
ZONE2
ZONE3
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND
BACK
FRONT
HEIGHT
FRONT
WIDE
NOTE
AM
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER1
SUBWOOFER2
ASSIGNABLE
•Do not touch the inner pins of the connectors on the rear panel. Electrostatic
discharge may cause permanent damage to the unit.
FM
(75Ω)
ASSIGNABLE
ANTENNA
SPEAKERS
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 6~8Ω
CLASS 2 WIRING
Q2Digital audio connectors (DIGITAL AUDIO)
Used to connect devices equipped with digital audio connectors
(vpage 41, 42, 44, 45).
Q3SIGNAL GND jacks
Used to connect a turntable (vpage 47).
Q4Network connector (NETWORK)
Used to connect this unit to the network (vpage 53).
Q5RS-232C connector
The RS-232C serial port is provided to allow compatibility with an
external home automation controller. Consult the owner’s manual
of the home automation controller for more information about serial
control of this unit. The serial port allows two-way control and status
via an external home automation controller.
Front panel
Appendix
Q6DC OUT jacks
Q7 Q6 Q5 Q4Q3 Q2
NETWORK
Tips
Display
Rear panel
23
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Remote control unit
qDisplay
q
w
e
r
t
qLEARN indicator
q
w
This is lit when setting the learning function for the remote control
unit (vpage 220).
wInformation display
•This displays “AVR” when operating this unit.
•This displays the input source name when operating an external
device.
•This displays “TV” when operating TV.
e indicator
This is lit when signals are sent from the remote control unit.
e
y
wAVR-operation mode button
When preset codes are registered to the remote control unit, press this
button and then operate the menu on the unit.
eSET button
This is used for various settings on the remote control unit
(vpage 212, 220, 223, 224).
rZONE SELECT button
These switch the zone (MAIN ZONE, ZONE2, ZONE3) that is operated
through the remote control unit (vpage 149, 158).
tDevice operation buttons (DEVICE X / DEVICE MENU)
These turn the power of external devices on/off and call up menus.
Preset codes need to be registered in order to use these buttons
(vpage 216).
yInput source select buttons
These select the input source (vpage 60, 149).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
24
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
uSLEEP button
This sets the sleep timer (vpage 135).
iChannel/page search buttons (CH/PAGE df)
These select preset radio stations or switch pages (vpage 74).
oInstaPrevue button
This displays the InstaPrevue screen (vpage 133).
Q0Information button (INFO)
This displays the status information on the TV screen (vpage 208).
Q1Cursor buttons (uio p)
These select items (vpage 158).
Q2BACK button
This returns to the previous screen (vpage 158).
Q3HOME button
u
This takes you to the Home screen (Top screen) when the input source
is NETWORK or iPod/USB (vpage 64).
i
o
Q0
Q4System buttons
These perform playback related operations (vpage 62).
•Stop button (2)
•Pause button (3)
•Play button (1)
•Skip buttons (8, 9)
•Search buttons (6, 7)
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
25
Tuning up / Tuning down buttons (TUNE +, –)
These operate the tuner (vpage 71).
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Q5FAVORITE STATION buttons (1 – 4)
With a single press of these, you can call up registered radio stations
and contents (vpage 105).
Q8
Q6SOUND MODE buttons
These select the sound mode (vpage 119).
•MOVIE button
•MUSIC button
•GAME button
•PURE button
Q9
W0
Q7Number buttons
These enter numbers into the unit (vpage 72, 160).
Q8Remote control signal transmitter
This transmits signals from the remote control unit (vpage 8).
Q9POWER button (X)
W1
W2
This turns the power on/off (vpage 60, 149).
W0TV operation buttons (TV X / TV INPUT)
These turn the TV power on/off, switch the TV input and call up menus.
Preset codes need to be registered in order to use these buttons
(vpage 216).
W1Light button
This turns on the backlight for approx. 2 seconds (vpage 223).
W2VOLUME buttons (df)
These adjust the volume level (vpage 61, 150).
Q5
Q6
Q7
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
26
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
W3MUTE button (
)
This mutes the output audio (vpage 61, 150).
W4OPTION button
This displays the option menu on the TV screen (vpage 110).
W5ENTER button
This determines the selection (vpage 158).
W6SETUP button
This displays the menu on the TV screen (vpage 158).
W3
W4
W5
W6
W5
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
27
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connections
22Cables used for connections
Speaker connection (vpage 29)
Provide necessary cables according to the devices you want to connect.
Connecting a TV (vpage 39)
Connecting a playback device (vpage 43)
Speaker cable
Connecting an iPod or USB memory device to the USB
port (vpage 49)
Subwoofer cable
HDMI cable
Connecting an HD Radio receiver (vpage 51)
Connecting to a home network (LAN) (vpage 53)
Component video cable
Connecting a wireless receiver (RX101) (vpage 55)
Video cable
Connecting an external control device (vpage 56)
Coaxial digital cable
Connecting the power cord (vpage 58)
Optical cable
NOTE
Audio cable
•Do not plug in the power cord until all connections have been completed.
However, when the “Setup Assistant” is running, follow the instructions in the
“Setup Assistant” (C page 7) screen for making connections. (During “Setup
Assistant” operation, the input/output connectors do not conduct current.)
•Do not bundle power cords together with connection cables. Doing so can result
in noise.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
L
L
R
R
LAN cable
28
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Speaker connection
Install speakers and connect them to this unit (vpage 29, 32).
Speaker installation
Determine the speaker system depending on the number of speakers you
are using and install each speaker and subwoofer in the room. Here, we
explain how to install the speakers using a typical example.
FHL
FHR
FL
FWL
FL/FR : Place the FRONT left and right speakers an equal distance from
the main listening position. The distance between each speaker
and your TV should also be the same.
C : Place the CENTER speaker in between the front speakers and above
or below your TV.
SL/SR : Place the SURROUND left and right speakers an equal distance
to the left and right sides of the main listening position. If you
don’t have Surround Back speakers, move the surround speakers
slightly behind your listening position.
SBL/SBR (SB) : Place the SURROUND BACK left and right speakers
an equal distance from the main listening position and
directly behind the main listening position. If you only
have one Surround Back speaker, center it.
FHL/FHR : Place the FRONT HEIGHT left and right speakers just outside
of the front left and right speakers. Mount them as close to the
ceiling as possible and aim them towards the main listening
position.
FWL/FWR : Place the FRONT WIDE left and right speakers outside of the
front left and right speakers so that there is an equal distance
between all front speakers.
SW 1/2 : Place the SUBWOOFER at a convenient location near the front
speakers. If you have two subwoofers, place them symmetrically
across the front of your room. If you have 2 subwoofers, place
them symmetrically across the front of your room.
FR
SW1
SW2
FWR
C
SL
SR
SBL
Front panel
SB
Display
SBR
Rear panel
29
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
NOTE
%
•Sound cannot be played simultaneously from all of the surround back, front height
and front wide speakers.
•This unit is compatible with Audyssey DSX® (vpage 257), Dolby Pro Logic gz
(vpage 259) and DTS Neo:X (vpage 260) which offers an even wider and
deeper surround sensation.
When using Audyssey DSX®, install front wide speakers or front height speakers.
When using Dolby Pro Logic gz, install front height speakers.
•Use the illustration below as a guide for how high each speaker should be installed.
The height does not need to be exactly the same.
Surround
Front height
speaker
speaker
•Point slightly
downwards
Front wide
At least
3.3 ft/1 mz1 speaker
2 – 3 ft/
z2
60 – 90 cm
Front
speaker
45˚
Surround back
speaker
•Point slightly
downwards
GViewed from the sideH
z1 Recommended for Dolby Pro Logic gz
z2 Recommended for Audyssey DSX®
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
30
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22When 5.1-channel speakers are installed
22Typical speaker layout
FHL
FHR
FR
FL SW
FWL
C
z3
FWR
z1
z2
z3
z4
z5
22˚ – 30˚
22˚ – 45˚
55˚ – 60˚
90˚ – 110˚
135˚ – 150˚
FL
z1 22˚ – 30˚
z2120˚
FR
SW
C
z1
z
z2
5
z
z2
z1
Appendix
Tips
4
SL
Listening
position
SL
SR
SBL
SR
SBR
%
•When using a single surround back speaker, place it directly behind the listening
position.
GSpeaker abbreviationsH
FL
FR
C
SW
SL
SR
Front speaker (L)
Front speaker (R)
Center speaker
Subwoofer
Surround speaker (L)
Surround speaker (R)
Front panel
SBL
SBR
FHL
FHR
FWL
FWR
Display
Surround back speaker (L)
Surround back speaker (R)
Front height speaker (L)
Front height speaker (R)
Front wide speaker (L)
Front wide speaker (R)
Rear panel
31
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and + (red) and –
(black) polarities on the speakers being connected to this unit, and be
sure to connect the channels and polarities correctly.
Here we connect the speakers in the room to this unit.
This section explains how to connect them using typical examples.
NOTE
•Disconnect this unit’s power plug from the power outlet before connecting the
speakers. Also, turn off the subwoofer.
•Connect so that the speaker cable core wires do not protrude from the speaker
terminal. The protection circuit may be activated if the core wires touch the rear
panel or if the + and – sides touch each other (vpage 262 “Protection circuit”).
•Never touch the speaker terminals while the power cord is connected. Doing so
could result in electric shock. When the “Setup Assistant” is running, follow the
instructions in the “Setup Assistant” (C page 7) screen for making connections.
(Power is not supplied to the speaker terminals while the “Setup Assistant” is
running.)
•Use speakers with an impedance of 6 – 8 Ω/ohms.
Display
Appendix
22Connecting the speaker cables
Speaker connection
Front panel
Tips
Rear panel
32
1
Peel off about 3/8 inch (10 mm) of
sheathing from the tip of the speaker
cable, then either twist the core wire
tightly or terminate it.
2
Turn the speaker terminal counterclockwise
to loosen it.
3
Insert the speaker cable’s core wire to the
hilt into the speaker terminal.
4
Turn the speaker terminal clockwise to
tighten it.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
22Connecting the subwoofer
Use a subwoofer cable to connect the subwoofer.
Two subwoofers can be connected to this unit.
To use two subwoofers, set “Subwoofer” to “2 spkrs” using the
“Speaker Config.” (vpage 194) setting.
The level and distance can be set separately for Subwoofer 1 and
Subwoofer 2.
7.1CH IN
AUDIO OUT
MEDIA
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURROUND
BACK
PLAYER
PRE OUT
ZONE2
ZONE3
FRONT CENTER
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
SURROUND SURROUND
BACK
HEIGHT
FRONT
WIDE
SUBWOOFER1 SUBWOOFER2
ASSIGNABLE
SPEAKERS
Front panel
IMPEDANCE : 6~8Ω
SW1
SW2
Display
Rear panel
33
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22About the speaker cable label (supplied) for
channel identification
Speaker
This unit
Color
White
Red
Green
Light blue
Blue
Beige
Brown
Light purple
Purple
Light yellow
Yellow
Attach the speaker cable label for each channel to its speaker cable as
shown in the diagram.
Then, make connection so that the color of the speaker terminal
matches that of the speaker cable label.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
GHow to attach the speaker cable labelH
The channel display section for speaker terminals on the rear panel is
color-coded for each channel to be identifiable.
Speaker terminals
FRONT L
FRONT R
CENTER
SURROUND L
SURROUND R
SURROUND BACK L
SURROUND BACK R
FRONT HEIGHT L
FRONT HEIGHT R
FRONT WIDE L
FRONT WIDE R
Tips
34
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
22Standard Speaker Connection
The figure below shows an example of standard speaker connection.
AUDIO OUT
7.1CH IN
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND
BACK
MEDIA
PLAYER
PRE OUT
ZONE2
ZONE3
FRONT
SUBWOOFER
CENTER
SUBWOOFER1
SURROUND
SURROUND
BACK
FRONT
HEIGHT
FRONT
WIDE
SUBWOOFER2
ASSIGNABLE
ASSIGNABLE
SW1
FR
FL
C
SR
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 6~8Ω
SPEAKERS
SL
SBR
SBL
CLASS 2 WIRING
FHR
FHL
FWR
%
FWL
•By connecting all speakers in advance, audio playback can be automatically switched between the surround back, front height and front wide speakers corresponding to the
sound mode and input signals.
•When using this connection, also set “Assign Mode” in the menu to “9.1ch(SB/FH/FW)” (vpage 192).
•When using a signal surround back speaker, connect it to the SURROUND BACK L terminal.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
35
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
22About the front B speaker connections
•For how to connect the front, center, and surround speaker and
the subwoofer to this unit, see “Standard Speaker Connection”
(vpage 35).
ASSIGNABLE
FR (B)
FL (B)
%
•When using this connection, also set “Assign Mode” in the menu to “7.1ch +
Front B” (vpage 192).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
36
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22About the Bi-amp connection
Some audiophile loudspeakers can be connected to an amplifier with two separate amp-to-speaker connections per each speaker. One amplifier
channel’s output is hooked up to the speaker’s bass driver (woofer), while the other amplifier drives the upper range transducers (tweeter, or in
some cases midrange and tweeter). This connection method has one amplifier channel driving one half of the bi-amp speaker, and avoids electrical
interference between the speaker’s bass and treble drivers and the driving amplifier channels. You can assign 4 amp channels to connect to one pair
of bi-amp capable speakers. Bi-amp capable speakers always have two sets of speaker input connector pairs, one for the bass range and one for
the treble range. If you’re unsure about whether or not your speakers are bi-amp capable, consult the owner’s manual that came with the speakers.
•For how to connect the center, surround speaker and the subwoofer to this unit, see “Standard Speaker Connection” (vpage 35).
AUDIO OUT
7.1CH IN
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND
BACK
MEDIA
PLAYER
PRE OUT
ZONE2
ZONE3
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
CENTER
SUBWOOFER1
SURROUND
BACK
SURROUND
FRONT
HEIGHT
FRONT
WIDE
SUBWOOFER2
ASSIGNABLE
ASSIGNABLE
(R)
q
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 6~8Ω
SPEAKERS
CLASS 2 WIRING
(L)
w
q
FR
%
•When using this connection, also set “Assign Mode” in the
menu to “7.1ch(Bi-Amp)” (vpage 192).
w
NOTE
FL
•When making bi-amp connections, be sure to remove the
short-circuiting plate or wire between the speaker’s woofer
and tweeter terminals.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
37
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22Connecting an external power amplifier
•You can use this unit as a pre-amp by connecting an external power amplifier to the PRE OUT connectors. Adding an external power amplifier with
a higher power output rating than this unit may be beneficial with loudspeakers that have lower efficiency and/or lower impedances, or to reach
higher volume levels.
•Select the terminal to use and connect the device.
Subwoofer
(Primary)
AUDIO
AUDIO
SUBWOOFER
1
AUDIO
FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURROUND
BACK
L
R
L
R
L
FRONT
HEIGHT
R
L
FRONT
WIDE
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
HDMI IN
DIGITAL AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
1 TV AUDIO
2 CD
NETWORK
Subwoofer
(Secondary)
Power amplifier
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
HDMI OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
SUBWOOFER
2
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
ZONE2
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
ARC
AC IN
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
1
2
COMPONENT VIDEO IN
1 CBL/SAT
Y
P B/
CB
PR/
CR
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
P B/
CB
Y
PR/
CR
IN
DC12V 150mA MAX.
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC OUT
RS-232C
AUDIO IN
1 CBL/SAT
(ASSIGNABLE) VIDEO OUT
VIDEO IN
MEDIA
MEDIA
1 CBL/
PLAYER
SAT 3 PLAYER
2 DVD
SIGNAL
GND
M-XPort
AUDIO IN
(ASSIGNABLE)
MEDIA
3 Blu-ray 4 PLAYER
FLASHER
5 CD
PHONO
OUT
2 DVD
MONITOR
CENTER
SURROUND
ZONE2
MONITOR/ZONE2
2 DVD
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
AUDIO OUT
7.1CH IN
FRONT
SURROUND
BACK
MEDIA
PLAYER
PRE OUT
ZONE2
ZONE3
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND
BACK
FRONT
HEIGHT
FRONT
WIDE
AM
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER1
SUBWOOFER2
ASSIGNABLE
FM
(75Ω)
ASSIGNABLE
ANTENNA
Front panel
SPEAKERS
Display
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 6~8Ω
Rear panel
CLASS 2 WIRING
38
%
•When using just one surround back speaker, connect it to the
left channel (L) terminal.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Connecting a TV
Connect a TV to this unit so that the input video is output to the TV. You can also enjoy audio from the TV on this unit.
How to connect a TV depends on the connectors and functions equipped on the TV.
ARC function plays TV audio on this unit by sending the TV audio signal to this unit via HDMI cable.
Is the TV equipped with an HDMI connector?
No
Yes
Is the TV compatible with the ARC (Audio
Return Channel) ?
Yes
No
Connection 1
(vpage 40)
Front panel
Display
Connection 2
(vpage 41)
Rear panel
39
Connection 3
(vpage 42)
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connection 1 : TV equipped with an HDMI connector and compatible with the ARC
(Audio Return Channel)
Use an HDMI cable to connect a TV that is compatible with the ARC function to this unit.
Set “HDMI Control” (vpage 174) to “On” when using a TV that supports the ARC function.
TV
HDMI
IN
(ARC)
HDMI IN
DIGITAL AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
1 TV AUDIO
2 CD
NETWORK
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
HDMI OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
ZONE2
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
ARC
AC IN
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
1
2
COMPONENT VIDEO IN
1 CBL/SAT
Y
P B/
CB
PR/
CR
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
PB/
CB
Y
PR/
CR
IN
DC12V 150mA MAX.
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC OUT
RS-232C
AUDIO IN
1 CBL/SAT
(ASSIGNABLE) VIDEO OUT
VIDEO IN
MEDIA
MEDIA
1 CBL/
PLAYER
SAT 3 PLAYER
2 DVD
SIGNAL
GND
FLASHER
M-XPort
AUDIO IN
(ASSIGNABLE)
MEDIA
3 Blu-ray 4 PLAYER
5 CD
PHONO
OUT
2 DVD
MONITOR
CENTER
SURROUND
ZONE2
MONITOR/ZONE2
2 DVD
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
AUDIO OUT
7.1CH IN
FRONT
SURROUND
BACK
MEDIA
PLAYER
PRE OUT
ZONE2
ZONE3
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND
BACK
FRONT
HEIGHT
FRONT
WIDE
AM
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER1
SUBWOOFER2
ASSIGNABLE
FM
(75Ω)
ASSIGNABLE
ANTENNA
Front panel
Display
SPEAKERS
Rear panel
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 6~8Ω
40
Remote
CLASS 2 WIRING
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connection 2 : TV equipped with an HDMI connector
Use an HDMI cable to connect the TV to this unit.
To listen to audio from TV on this unit, use an optical cable to connect the TV to this unit.
TV
OUT
IN
OPTICAL
OUT
HDMI
IN
HDMI IN
DIGITAL AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
1 TV AUDIO
2 CD
NETWORK
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
HDMI OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
ZONE2
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
ARC
AC IN
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
1
2
COMPONENT VIDEO IN
1 CBL/SAT
Y
P B/
CB
PR/
CR
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
P B/
CB
Y
PR/
CR
IN
DC12V 150mA MAX.
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC OUT
RS-232C
AUDIO IN
1 CBL/SAT
(ASSIGNABLE) VIDEO OUT
VIDEO IN
MEDIA
MEDIA
1 CBL/
PLAYER
SAT 3 PLAYER
2 DVD
SIGNAL
GND
M-XPort
AUDIO IN
(ASSIGNABLE)
MEDIA
3 Blu-ray 4 PLAYER
FLASHER
5 CD
PHONO
OUT
2 DVD
MONITOR
CENTER
SURROUND
ZONE2
MONITOR/ZONE2
2 DVD
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
AUDIO OUT
7.1CH IN
FRONT
SURROUND
BACK
MEDIA
PLAYER
PRE OUT
ZONE2
ZONE3
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND
BACK
FRONT
HEIGHT
FRONT
WIDE
AM
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER1
SUBWOOFER2
ASSIGNABLE
%
FM
•To output audio signals that are input from the HDMI input connector
to a TV connected via HDMI, set “HDMI Audio Out” (vpage 173)
to “TV”.
(75Ω)
ASSIGNABLE
ANTENNA
Front panel
SPEAKERS
Display
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 6~8Ω
Rear panel
CLASS 2 WIRING
41
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Connection 3 : TV equipped without an HDMI connector
Use a video or a component cable to connect the TV to this unit.
To listen to audio from TV on this unit, use an optical cable to connect the TV to this unit.
TV
OUT
IN
COMPONENT VIDEO
IN
Y
P B PR
VIDEO
IN
OPTICAL
OUT
or
HDMI IN
DIGITAL AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
1 TV AUDIO
2 CD
NETWORK
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
HDMI OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
ZONE2
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
ARC
AC IN
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
1
2
COMPONENT VIDEO IN
1 CBL/SAT
Y
P B/
CB
PR/
CR
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
P B/
CB
Y
PR/
CR
IN
DC12V 150mA MAX.
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC OUT
RS-232C
AUDIO IN
1 CBL/SAT
(ASSIGNABLE) VIDEO OUT
VIDEO IN
MEDIA
MEDIA
1 CBL/
PLAYER
SAT 3 PLAYER
2 DVD
SIGNAL
GND
FLASHER
M-XPort
AUDIO IN
(ASSIGNABLE)
MEDIA
3 Blu-ray 4 PLAYER
5 CD
PHONO
OUT
2 DVD
MONITOR
CENTER
SURROUND
ZONE2
MONITOR/ZONE2
2 DVD
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
AUDIO OUT
7.1CH IN
FRONT
SURROUND
BACK
MEDIA
PLAYER
PRE OUT
ZONE2
ZONE3
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND
BACK
FRONT
HEIGHT
FRONT
WIDE
AM
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER1
SUBWOOFER2
ASSIGNABLE
FM
(75Ω)
ASSIGNABLE
ANTENNA
Front panel
Display
SPEAKERS
Rear panel
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 6~8Ω
42
Remote
CLASS 2 WIRING
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connecting a playback device
This unit is equipped with three types of video input connectors (HDMI, component video and composite video) and three types of video output
connectors (HDMI, component video and composite video).
Select input connectors on this unit according to the connectors equipped on the device you want to connect.
If the device connected to this unit is equipped with an HDMI connector, it is recommended to use HDMI connections.
In the HDMI connection, audio and video signals can be transmitted through a single HDMI cable.
•Connecting a set-top box (Satellite tuner/cable TV) (vpage 44)
•Connecting a DVD player (vpage 45)
•Connecting a video camcorder or other device (vpage 46)
•Connecting a turntable (vpage 47)
•Connecting a device with a multi-channel output connector (vpage 48)
%
•Connect devices to this unit as indicated by the input sources printed on the audio/video input connectors of this unit.
•This unit can change the source that is assigned to the HDMI IN, DIGITAL AUDIO IN, COMPONENT VIDEO IN, VIDEO IN and AUDIO IN connectors.
How to change the source assigned to connectors (vpage 179 “Input Assign”).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
43
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Connecting a set-top box (Satellite tuner/cable TV)
This explanation uses the connection with a satellite tuner/cable TV STB as an example.
Select input connectors on this unit according to the connectors equipped on the device you want to connect.
(HDMI incompatible device)
Satellite tuner/Cable TV
AUDIO
VIDEO
VIDEO
OUT
COAXIAL
OUT
AUDIO
OUT
L
R
Satellite tuner/
Cable TV
COMPONENT VIDEO
OUT
Y
PB PR
HDMI
OUT
R
L
or
or
R
L
HDMI IN
DIGITAL AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
1 TV AUDIO
2 CD
NETWORK
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
HDMI OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
ZONE2
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
ARC
AC IN
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
1
2
COMPONENT VIDEO IN
1 CBL/SAT
Y
P B/
CB
PR/
CR
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
P B/
CB
Y
PR/
CR
IN
DC12V 150mA MAX.
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC OUT
RS-232C
AUDIO IN
1 CBL/SAT
(ASSIGNABLE) VIDEO OUT
VIDEO IN
MEDIA
MEDIA
1 CBL/
PLAYER
SAT 3 PLAYER
2 DVD
SIGNAL
GND
FLASHER
M-XPort
AUDIO IN
(ASSIGNABLE)
MEDIA
3 Blu-ray 4 PLAYER
5 CD
PHONO
OUT
2 DVD
MONITOR
CENTER
SURROUND
ZONE2
MONITOR/ZONE2
2 DVD
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
AUDIO OUT
7.1CH IN
FRONT
SURROUND
BACK
MEDIA
PLAYER
PRE OUT
ZONE2
ZONE3
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND
BACK
FRONT
HEIGHT
FRONT
WIDE
AM
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER1
SUBWOOFER2
ASSIGNABLE
FM
(75Ω)
ASSIGNABLE
ANTENNA
Front panel
Display
SPEAKERS
Rear panel
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 6~8Ω
44
Remote
CLASS 2 WIRING
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Connecting a DVD player
This explanation uses the connection with a DVD players as an example.
Select input connectors on this unit according to the connectors equipped on the device you want to connect.
(HDMI incompatible device)
DVD player
AUDIO
DVD player
VIDEO
VIDEO
OUT
COAXIAL
OUT
AUDIO
OUT
L
R
COMPONENT VIDEO
OUT
Y
P B PR
HDMI
OUT
R
L
or
or
R
L
HDMI IN
DIGITAL AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
1 TV AUDIO
2 CD
NETWORK
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
HDMI OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
ZONE2
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
ARC
AC IN
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
1
2
COMPONENT VIDEO IN
1 CBL/SAT
Y
P B/
CB
PR/
CR
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
P B/
CB
Y
PR/
CR
IN
DC12V 150mA MAX.
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC OUT
RS-232C
AUDIO IN
1 CBL/SAT
(ASSIGNABLE) VIDEO OUT
VIDEO IN
MEDIA
MEDIA
1 CBL/
PLAYER
SAT 3 PLAYER
2 DVD
SIGNAL
GND
M-XPort
AUDIO IN
(ASSIGNABLE)
MEDIA
3 Blu-ray 4 PLAYER
FLASHER
5 CD
PHONO
OUT
2 DVD
MONITOR
CENTER
SURROUND
ZONE2
MONITOR/ZONE2
2 DVD
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
AUDIO OUT
7.1CH IN
FRONT
SURROUND
BACK
MEDIA
PLAYER
PRE OUT
ZONE2
ZONE3
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND
BACK
FRONT
HEIGHT
FRONT
WIDE
AM
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER1
SUBWOOFER2
ASSIGNABLE
FM
(75Ω)
ASSIGNABLE
ANTENNA
Front panel
Display
SPEAKERS
Rear panel
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 6~8Ω
45
Remote
CLASS 2 WIRING
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Connecting a video camcorder or other device
This explanation uses the connection with a video camcorders as an example.
Connect a playback device to this unit, such as a video camcorder or game console.
(HDMI incompatible
device)
Video camcorder
Front panel
AUDIO
VIDEO
AUDIO
OUT
L
R
VIDEO
OUT
L
R
L
R
Display
Video
camcorder
HDMI
OUT
Rear panel
46
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connecting a turntable
This unit is compatible with turntables equipped with a moving magnet (MM) phono cartridge. When you connect to a turntable with a low output moving
coil (MC) cartridge, use a commercially available MC head amp or a step-up transformer.
If you set this unit’s input source to “PHONO” and you accidentally increase the volume without having a turntable connected, you may hear a hum noise
from the speakers.
Turntable
(MM cartridge)
AUDIO
OUT
GND
R
L
HDMI IN
DIGITAL AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
1 TV AUDIO
2 CD
NETWORK
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
HDMI OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
ZONE2
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
ARC
AC IN
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
1
2
COMPONENT VIDEO IN
1 CBL/SAT
Y
P B/
CB
PR/
CR
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
PB/
CB
Y
PR/
CR
IN
DC12V 150mA MAX.
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC OUT
RS-232C
AUDIO IN
1 CBL/SAT
(ASSIGNABLE) VIDEO OUT
VIDEO IN
MEDIA
MEDIA
1 CBL/
PLAYER
SAT 3 PLAYER
2 DVD
SIGNAL
GND
M-XPort
AUDIO IN
(ASSIGNABLE)
MEDIA
3 Blu-ray 4 PLAYER
FLASHER
5 CD
PHONO
OUT
2 DVD
MONITOR
CENTER
SURROUND
ZONE2
MONITOR/ZONE2
2 DVD
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
AUDIO OUT
7.1CH IN
FRONT
SURROUND
BACK
MEDIA
PLAYER
PRE OUT
ZONE2
ZONE3
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND
BACK
FRONT
HEIGHT
FRONT
WIDE
AM
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER1
SUBWOOFER2
ASSIGNABLE
NOTE
FM
•The ground line (SIGNAL GND) on this unit is not a safety ground. Note
that depending on the turntable, connecting the ground line may have
the reverse effect of increasing noise. In this case, it is not necessary
to connect the ground line.
(75Ω)
ASSIGNABLE
ANTENNA
Front panel
SPEAKERS
Display
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 6~8Ω
Rear panel
CLASS 2 WIRING
47
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connecting a device with a multi-channel output connector
You can connect this unit to an external device fitted with multi-channel sound audio output connectors to enjoy music and video.
To play analog signals input from 7.1CH IN connectors, set “Input Mode” (vpage 182) to “7.1CH IN”.
Devices with a multi-channel output connector
(Blu-ray Disc player, DVD player,
External decoder etc.)
AUDIO
SUBWOOFER
FRONT
L
NETWORK
CENTER
SURROUND
R
L
SURROUND
BACK
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
HDMI IN (ASSIGNABLE)
DIGITAL AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
1 CBL/SAT 2 DVD 1 TV AUDIO 2 CD
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
HDMI OUT
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
ZONE2
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
ARC
AC IN
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
1
2
VIDEO IN (ASSIGNABLE) VIDEO OUT
MEDIA
MEDIA
1 CBL/
SAT 3 PLAYER PLAYER Y
COMPONENT VIDEO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
1 CBL/SAT
PB/
CB
PR/
CR
Y
PB/
CB
PR/
CR
IN
DC12V 150mA MAX.
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC OUT
RS-232C
SIGNAL
GND
AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
MEDIA
1 CBL/SAT 2 DVD 3 Blu-ray 4 PLAYER
FLASHER
AUDIO IN
5 CD
M-XPort
OUT
2 DVD
MONITOR ZONE2
7.1CH IN
2 DVD
MONITOR/ZONE2
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
AUDIO OUT
MEDIA
PHONO FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURROUND
BACK
PLAYER
PRE OUT
ZONE2
ZONE3
FRONT CENTER
FRONT
SURROUND SURROUND
BACK
HEIGHT
FRONT
WIDE
%
AM
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER1 SUBWOOFER2
ASSIGNABLE
FM
(75Ω)
ASSIGNABLE
ANTENNA
Front panel
SPEAKERS
Display
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 6~8Ω
Rear panel
CLASS 2 WIRING
48
•The video signal can be connected in the same way as a DVD
player (vpage 45 “Connecting a DVD player”).
•When a device is connected to the SBL/SBR terminal of
7.1CH IN connectors, set “Assign Mode” (vpage 192) to
“9.1ch(SB/FH/FW)”.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connecting an iPod or USB memory device to the USB port
To connect an iPod to this unit, use the USB adapter cable that was supplied with the iPod.
For operating instructions see “Playing an iPod” (vpage 62) or “Playing a USB memory device” (vpage 67).
USB
memory
device
iPod
or
%
•Marantz does not guarantee that all USB memory devices will operate or receive power. When using a portable USB hard disk drive (HDD) which came with an AC adapter,
use that device’s supplied AC adapter.
NOTE
•USB memory devices will not work via a USB hub.
•It is not possible to use this unit by connecting the unit’s USB port to a PC via a USB cable.
•Do not use an extension cable when connecting a USB memory device. This may cause radio interference with other devices.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
49
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
22Supported iPod/iPhone models
•iPod classic
•iPod nano
•iPod touch
•iPhone
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
50
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
Connecting an HD Radio receiver
HD Radio broadcasting currently is available in
the United States and select other countries.
After connecting the antenna and receiving a
broadcast signal (vpage 71 “Listening to
HD Radio broadcasts”), fix the antenna with
tape in a position where the noise level becomes
minimal.
Direction of broadcasting station
FM outdoor
antenna
AM loop antenna
(for HD Radio broadcasting, supplied)
75 Ω/ohms
coaxial cable
q
w
e
DIGITAL AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
1 TV AUDIO
2 CD
NETWORK
COAXIAL
1 CBL/SAT
OPTICAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
1
2
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC OUT
RS-232C
AUDIO IN
AM
FM
(75Ω)
(ASSIGNABLE) VIDEO OUT
VIDEO IN
MEDIA
MEDIA
1 CBL/
PLAYER
SAT 3 PLAYER
COMPONENT VIDEO IN
1 CBL/SAT
Y
P B/
CB
IN
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
2 DVD
SIGNAL
GND
FLASHER
M-XPort
AUDIO IN
(ASSIGNABLE)
MEDIA
3 Blu-ray 4 PLAYER
5 CD
PHONO
OUT
2 DVD
MONITOR
White
CENTER
SURROUND
ZONE2
2 DVD
AUDIO OUT
7.1CH IN
FRONT
SURROUND
BACK
MEDIA
PLAYER
ZONE2
ZONE3
SUBWOOFER
Black
ANTENNA
SPEAKERS
FM indoor antenna
(for HD Radio broadcasting, supplied)
Ground
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
51
Remote
Index
AM outdoor
antenna
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22AM loop antenna assembly
Appendix
22Using the AM loop antenna
1
Put the stand section through the bottom of the loop
antenna from the rear and bend it forward.
2
Insert the projecting part into the square hole in the
stand.
Suspending on a wall
Suspend directly on a wall without
assembling.
Nail, tack, etc.
Standing alone
Stand
Loop
antenna
Tips
Use the procedure shown above to
assemble.
Square
hole
Projecting
part
NOTE
•Do not connect two FM antennas simultaneously.
•Even if an external AM antenna is used, do not disconnect the AM loop antenna.
•Make sure the AM loop antenna lead terminals do not touch metal parts of the
panel.
•If the signal has noise interference, connect the ground terminal (GND) to reduce
noise.
•If you are unable to receive a good broadcast signal, we recommend installing an
outdoor antenna. For details, inquire at the retail store where you purchased the
unit.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
52
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
Connecting to a home network (LAN)
You can connect this unit to your home network (LAN) to perform various types of playbacks and operations as follows.
•Playback of network audio such as Internet
Radio and from your media server(s)
•Playback of music content from online
streaming services
•Using the Apple AirPlay function
•Operation on this unit via the network
•Firmware Update
NAS
(Network Attached
Storage)
PC
Modem
Internet
%
To WAN side
•With this unit, it is possible to use the DHCP and
Auto IP functions to make the network settings
automatically.
•When using this unit connected to a network with no
DHCP function, make the settings for the IP address,
etc., at “Network” (vpage 199).
To LAN port
LAN port/
Ethernet
connector
To LAN port
LAN port/
Ethernet
connector
Router
NETWORK
HDMI IN (ASSIGNABLE)
DIGITAL AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
1 CBL/SAT 2 DVD 1 TV AUDIO 2 CD
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
HDMI OUT
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
ZONE2
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
ARC
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
1
2
DC12V 150mA MAX.
VIDEO IN (ASSIGNABLE) VIDEO OUT
MEDIA
MEDIA
1 CBL/
SAT 3 PLAYER PLAYER Y
COMPONENT VIDEO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
1 CBL/SAT
PB/
CB
PR/
CR
Y
PB/
CB
PR/
CR
IN
STRAIGHT CABLE
MONITOR/ZONE2
SIGNAL
GND
For connections to the Internet, contact an ISP (Internet Service Provider) or a computer
shop.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
53
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
%
•When using this unit, we recommend you use a router equipped with the following
functions:
•Built-in DHCP server
This function automatically assigns IP addresses on the LAN.
•Built-in 100BASE-TX switch
When connecting multiple devices, we recommend a switching hub with a speed
of 100 Mbps or greater.
•Use only a shielded STP or ScTP LAN cable which is easily available at electronics
stores (CAT-5 or greater recommended).
•The normal shielded-type LAN cable is recommended. If a flat-type cable or
unshielded-type cable is used, other devices could be affected by noise.
NOTE
•The types of routers that can be used depend on the ISP. Contact your ISP or a
computer shop for details.
•This unit is not compatible with PPPoE. A PPPoE-compatible router is required if
you have a contract for a type of line set by PPPoE.
•Do not connect an NETWORK connector directly to the LAN port/ Ethernet
connector on your computer.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
54
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
Connecting a wireless receiver (RX101)
You can connect a wireless receiver (RX101,
sold separately) to play back music on your
Bluetooth device with this unit.
To do this, switch the input source to “M-XPort”
(vpage 60 “Selecting the input source”).
Wireless receiver (RX101)
%
M-XPort
•When connecting your Bluetooth device to the
wireless receiver for the first time, paring is necessary.
Once paring is completed, the communication
between your Bluetooth device and the wireless
receiver can be established just by connecting them.
Paring is necessary for each Bluetooth device.
•You can also use the wireless receiver as an IR
receiver. In this case, disable the remote control
signal receiving function (vpage 143 “Remote
lock function”).
•This unit supports the A2DP standard of the
Bluetooth profile.
DIGITAL AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
1 TV AUDIO
2 CD
NETWORK
COAXIAL
1 CBL/SAT
OPTICAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
1
2
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC OUT
RS-232C
AUDIO IN
Bluetooth device
(A2DP Compatibility)
(ASSIGNABLE) VIDEO OUT
VIDEO IN
MEDIA
MEDIA
1 CBL/
PLAYER
SAT 3 PLAYER
Y
IN
DC12V 150mA MAX.
1 CBL/SAT
2 DV
2 DVD
SIGNAL
GND
FLASHER
M-XPort
AUDIO IN
(ASSIGNABLE)
MEDIA
3 Blu-ray 4 PLAYER
5 CD
PHONO
OUT
2 DVD
MONITOR
CENTER
SURROUND
ZONE2
AUDIO OUT
7.1CH IN
FRONT
SURROUND
BACK
MEDIA
PLAYER
ZON
AM
SUBWOOFER
FM
(75Ω)
ANTENNA
Remote control unit
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
55
Remote
Index
SPEAKE
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Connecting an external control device
Remotely connecting Marantz devices
22Remotely connecting Marantz devices
22Performing operations by RC on this unit
without visual contact
When you are using a Marantz device other than this unit that supports
remote connection, you can transmit remote control signals just by
connecting the device to the REMOTE CONTROL IN/ OUT connector
with a monaural cable.
Set the remote control switch located on the rear panel of the connected
audio component to “EXTERNAL” or “EXT.” to use this feature.
You can connect an external IR receiver to the REMOTE CONTROL
connectors to perform operations on this unit with the supplied remote
control unit without visual contact. This might be necessary if the unit
is hidden in a cupboard or corner, so you can’t directly point with the
remote control unit to the device.
To do this, disable the remote control signal receiving function
(vpage 143 “Remote lock function”).
COAXIAL
IR receiver
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
DIGITAL AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
1 TV AUDIO
2 CD
NETWORK
OPTICAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
NETWORK
DIGITAL AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
1 CBL/SAT 2 DVD 1 TV AUDIO 2 CD
1 CBL/SAT
RC OUT
1
2 DVD
2
DC12V 150mA MAX.
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC OUT
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
1
2
RS-232C
AUDIO IN
VIDEO IN (ASSIGNABLE) VIDEO OUT
MEDIA
1 CBL/ 3 MEDIA PLAYER
SAT
PLAYER
Y
1 CBL/SAT
VIDEO IN
CBL/
1 SAT
IN
2 DVD
SIGNAL
GND
OUT
FLASHER
M-XPort
AUDIO IN
(ASSIGNABLE)
MEDIA
3 Blu-ray 4 PLAYER
5 CD
PHONO
OUT
2 DVD
7.1CH IN
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
IN
AM
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
DC12V 150mA MAX.
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC OUT
RS-232C
SIGNAL
GND
AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
MEDIA
1 CBL/SAT 2 DVD 3 Blu-ray 4 PLAYER
FLASHER
AUDIO IN
5 CD
M-XPort
OUT
2 DVD
SUBWOOFER
MONITOR ZONE2
7.1CH IN
AUDIO OUT
MEDIA
PHONO FRONT CENTER SURROUND SURROUND
BACK
PLAYER
ZONE2
FM
(75Ω)
AM
SUBWOOFER
ANTENNA
FM
OUT
(75Ω)
ANTENNA
SPEAKERS
NOTE
•When the remote control signal receiving function is disabled, you can not perform
operations with the remote control unit.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
56
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Remotely control a Marantz Blu-ray Disc
player by the Marantz Remote App
Appendix
Tips
DC OUT jack
When a device with DC IN jack is connected, the connected device’s
power on/standby can be controlled through linked operation to this unit.
The DC OUT jack outputs a maximum 12 V/150 mA electrical signal.
Marantz Blu-ray Disc player of newer generation also can be controlled
via a network receiver unit using the Marantz Remote App. Please ensure
REMOTE CONTROL system of the receiver unit and the Blu-ray Disc
player is set up as shown in the previous section.
12 V/150 mA trigger-compatible device
HDMI IN
DIGITAL AUDIO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
1 TV AUDIO
2 CD
NETWORK
1 CBL/SAT
2 DVD
HDMI OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
ZONE2
MONITOR1
ARC
COAXIAL
OPTICAL
REMOTE
CONTROL
IN
1
2
COMPONENT VIDEO IN
1 CBL/SAT
Y
PB/
CB
PR/
CR
(ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
PB/
CB
Y
PR/
CR
IN
DC12V 150mA MAX.
STRAIGHT CABLE
DC OUT
RS-232C
AUDIO IN
1 CBL/SAT
(ASSIGNABLE) VIDEO OUT
VIDEO IN
MEDIA
1 CBL/ 3 MEDIA
PLAYER
SAT
PLAYER
2 DVD
SIGNAL
GND
FLASHER
M-XPort
AUDIO IN
(ASSIGNABLE)
MEDIA
3 Blu-ray 4 PLAYER
5 CD
PHONO
OUT
2 DVD
MONITOR
CENTER
SURROUND
ZONE2
MONITOR/ZONE2
2 DVD
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
AUDIO OUT
7.1CH IN
FRONT
SURROUND
BACK
MEDIA
PLAYER
PRE OUT
ZONE2
ZONE3
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND
SURROUND
BACK
FRONT
HEIGHT
FRONT
WIDE
AM
SUBWOOFER
SUBWOOFER1
SUBWOOFER2
ASSIGNABLE
FM
(75Ω)
ASSIGNABLE
ANTENNA
SPEAKERS
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 6~8Ω
CLASS 2 WIRING
NOTE
•Use the monaural mini-plug cable for connecting DC OUT jacks. Do not use the
stereo mini-plug cable.
•If the permissible trigger input level for the connected device is larger than 12
V/150 mA, or has shorted, the DC OUT jack cannot be used. In this case, turn off
the power to the unit, and disconnect it.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
57
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Connecting the power cord
After completing all the connections, insert the power plug into the power outlet.
HDMI OUT
(ASSIGNABLE)
4 GAME
5 MEDIA PLAYER
6 AUX2
ZONE2
MONITOR1
MONITOR2
ARC
AC IN
COMPONENT VIDEO IN (ASSIGNABLE)
3 Blu-ray
Y
PB/
CB
PR/
CR
MONITOR/ZONE2
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
PRE OUT
CENTER
FRONT
SURROUND SURROUND
BACK
HEIGHT
FRONT
WIDE
SUBWOOFER1 SUBWOOFER2
ASSIGNABLE
ASSIGNABLE
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 6~8Ω
CLASS 2 WIRING
Power cord (supplied)
To household power outlet
(AC 120 V, 60 Hz)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
58
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Playback
Turning the power on (vpage 60)
AirPlay function (vpage 107)
Selecting the input source (vpage 60)
Convenience functions (vpage 110)
Adjusting the master volume (vpage 61)
Selecting a sound mode (vpage 118)
Turning off the sound temporarily (vpage 61)
HDMI control function (vpage 132)
Playing a DVD player/Blu-ray Disc player (vpage 61)
InstaPrevue function (vpage 133)
Playing an iPod (vpage 62)
Sleep timer function (vpage 135)
Playing a USB memory device (vpage 67)
Rec out function (vpage 136)
Listening to HD Radio™ stations (vpage 70)
Web control function (vpage 138)
Listening to Internet Radio (vpage 79)
Dual backup memory function (vpage 140)
Playing back files stored on a PC and NAS (vpage 83)
Panel lock function (vpage 141)
Viewing photographs on the Flickr site (vpage 87)
Remote lock function (vpage 143)
Listening to Pandora® (vpage 91)
Switches light illumination on/off (vpage 144)
Listening to SiriusXM Internet Radio (vpage 98)
Playback in ZONE2/ZONE3 (Separate room)
(vpage 145)
Listening to Spotify (vpage 101)
Adding to the FAVORITE STATION button (vpage 105)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
59
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Basic operation
Turning the power on
1
POWER X
Press POWER X to turn on power to the unit.
%
•You can also switch the power to standby by pressing X on the main unit.
Input source
select buttons
Selecting the input source
1
VOLUME df
MUTE
Press the input source select button to be played back.
The desired input source can be selected directly.
%
•You can also select the input source by turning INPUT SELECTOR knob on the
main unit.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
60
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Adjusting the master volume
1
The following describes the procedure for playing DVD player/Blu-ray Disc
player.
•The variable range differs according to the input signal and channel
level setting.
%
•You can also adjust the master volume by turning VOLUME on the main unit.
Turning off the sound temporarily
1
.
•“MUTE” appears on the display.
•
appears on the TV screen.
1
Prepare for playback.
qTurn on the power of the TV, subwoofer and player.
wChange the TV input to the input of this unit.
2
3
Press POWER X to turn on power to the unit.
4
Play the DVD player or Blu-ray Disc player.
Press DVD or Blu-ray to switch an input source for a
player used for playback.
%
•The sound is reduced to the level set at “Mute Level” (vpage 167).
again. Muting can also be cancelled by adjusting the
•To cancel, press MUTE
master volume.
Front panel
Display
Appendix
Playing a DVD player/Blu-ray Disc player
Use VOLUME df to adjust the volume.
Press MUTE
Tips
Rear panel
61
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Playing an iPod
•You can use the USB cable provided with the iPod to connect the iPod
with the unit’s USB port and enjoy music stored on the iPod.
•For information on the iPod models that can be played back with this
unit, see “Supported iPod/iPhone models” (vpage 50).
iPod/USB
CH/PAGE df
OPTION
uio p
ENTER
BACK
2
3
1
89
67
HOME
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
62
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Operations available through the OPTION
button
Connect the iPod to the USB port (vpage 49).
•iPod Browse Mode Settings (vpage 64)
•Playing the Same Music in All Zones (All Zone Stereo) (vpage 117)
Press iPod/USB to switch the input source to “iPod/
USB”.
“Browse From iPod” is displayed on the display of this unit.
•Nothing is displayed on the TV screen.
3
Operate iPod itself directly while seeing the iPod screen
to play back music.
%
•“iPod Browse Mode” has two modes, “From iPod” and “On-Screen”.
By default, “From iPod”, where you directly operate the iPod itself while looking
at the iPod screen, is set.
•To change to “On-Screen”, where you perform operations while having the
iPod information displayed on the TV screen, see “iPod Browse Mode Settings”
(vpage 64).
NOTE
•Depending on the type of iPod and the software version, some functions may not
operate.
•Note that Marantz will accept no responsibility whatsoever for any problems arising
with the data on an iPod when using this unit in conjunction with the iPod.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
22Playing the AirPlay (vpage 107)
Listening to music on an iPod
1
2
Tips
63
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
iPod Browse Mode Settings
3
In this mode, various lists and screens during playback on the iPod are
displayed on the TV screen.
This section describes the steps up to playing back tracks on the iPod in
“On-Screen”.
1
Press OPTION when the input source is “iPod/USB”.
2
Select “iPod Browse Mode”, then press ENTER.
Appendix
Tips
Use o p to select “On-Screen”, then press ENTER.
•Operations available for “On-Screen” and “From iPod” are listed
below.
iPod Browse Mode
Playable
files
The option menu screen is displayed.
Active
buttons
The “iPod Browse Mode” screen is displayed.
From iPod
On-Screen
Music file
P
P
Video file
z
Remote
control unit
(This unit)
P
iPod
P
P
zz Only the sound is played.
4
Use ui p to select the file to be played, then press
ENTER.
Playback starts.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
64
Remote
Index
Contents
Operation buttons
1
3
2
8 9
6 7
ENTER
ui
CH/PAGE df
HOME
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
22Operations available through the OPTION
button
Function
Playback
Pause
Stop
Skip to previous track/Skip to next track
(Press and hold)
Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
Playback / Pause
(Press and hold)
Stop
Skip to previous track/Skip to next track
(Press and hold)
Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
Switch to previous page/switch to next
page in the list display
Go to Home screen
•Performing repeat playback (vpage 66)
•Performing random playback (vpage 66)
•Playing the Same Music in All Zones (All Zone Stereo) (vpage 117)
%
•The display switches between track title, artist name, and album title etc. each
time the main unit’s STATUS is pressed during playback with “iPod Browse Mode”
set to “On-Screen”.
•English letters, numbers and certain symbols are displayed. Incompatible
characters are displayed as “.” (period).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
65
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Performing repeat playback
1
4
Appendix
Performing random playback
Press OPTION with “iPod Browse Mode” set to
“On-Screen”.
1
Use ui to select “Repeat”, then press ENTER.
2
3
Use ui to select “Random”, then press ENTER.
4
Press ENTER.
The option menu screen is displayed.
2
3
Tips
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use o p to select repeat playback mode.
Off (Default) : R
epeat playback mode is canceled.
One : A
file being played is played repeatedly.
All : All files in the folder currently being played are played
repeatedly.
Press ENTER.
Display
Use o p to select random playback mode.
Off (Default) : Disable random playback.
On : Randomly play back all tracks in the current playback folder.
The display returns to the playback screen.
%
The display returns to the playback screen.
Front panel
Press OPTION with “iPod Browse Mode” set to
“On-Screen”.
•During random playback, each time playback of a track is completed, another track
is randomly selected for playback from tracks in the folder. Therefore, it’s possible
that you may hear a track played back more than once during random playback.
Rear panel
66
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Playing a USB memory device
•Playing back music or viewing still picture (JPEG) files stored on a USB
memory device.
•Only USB memory devices conforming to mass storage class and MTP
(Media Transfer Protocol) standards can be played on this unit.
•This unit is compatible with USB memory devices in “FAT16” or
“FAT32” format.
•This unit can play back the following files.
•WMA (Windows Media Audio)
•MP3 (MPEG-1 Audio Layer-3)
•WAV
•MPEG-4 AAC
•FLAC (Free Lossless Audio Codec)
•JPEG
•ALAC (Apple Lossless Audio Codec)
iPod/USB
CH/PAGE df
OPTION
uio p
ENTER
BACK
2
3
1
89
67
HOME
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
67
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Playing files stored on USB memory
devices
1
Connect the USB memory device to the USB port
(vpage 49).
2
Press iPod/USB to switch the input source to “iPod/
USB”.
USB
Operation buttons
1
3
2
8 9
6 7
ENTER
[1/9]
ui
Folder1
Folder2
Folder3
Music1
CH/PAGE df
Music2
Music3
HOME
Music4
OPTION
3
Tips
Appendix
Function
Playback
Pause
Stop
Skip to previous track/Skip to next track
(Press and hold)
Fast-reverse / Fast-forwardz
Playback / Pause
(Press and hold)
Stop
Skip to previous track/Skip to next track
(Press and hold)
Fast-reverse / Fast-forwardz
Switch to previous page/switch to next
page in the list display
Go to Home screen
zz This function is available while an MP3 / WAV / AAC / FLAC file is being played
back.
Option
%
Use ui p to select the file to be played, then press
ENTER.
•When an MP3 music file includes album art data, the album art can be displayed
while playing the file.
•This unit plays back picture (JPEG) files in the order in which they are stored in
the folder.
Playback starts.
NOTE
•Note that Marantz will accept no responsibility whatsoever for any problems arising
with the data on a USB memory device when using this unit in conjunction with
the USB memory device.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
68
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
22Operations available through the OPTION
button
•Performing repeat playback (vpage 111)
•Performing random playback (vpage 111)
•Searching content with keywords (Text Search) (vpage 113)
•Playing back music and a favorite picture at the same time (Slideshow)
(vpage 114)
•Setting the Slideshow Interval (vpage 115)
•Adjusting the picture quality for your viewing environment (Picture
Mode) (vpage 116)
•Playing the Same Music in All Zones (All Zone Stereo) (vpage 117)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
69
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Listening to HD Radio™ stations
•HD Radio stations offer higher sound quality than conventional FM/
AM broadcasts. It is also possible to receive data services and select
broadcasts from among up to eight multicast programs.
•HD Radio Technology provides higher quality sound than conventional
broadcasts and allows reception of data services.
TUNER
•Digital, CD-quality sound. HD Radio Technology enables local radio
stations to broadcast a clean digital signal. AM sounds like today’s FM
and FM sounds like a CD.
CH/PAGE df
•Program Service Data: Contributes to the superior user experience of
HD Radio Technology. Presents song name, artist, station IDs, and
other relevant data streams.
OPTION
uio p
ENTER
BACK
TUNE +, –
FAVORITE
STATION
1–4
0–9
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
70
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
Listening to HD Radio broadcasts
1
•Adjacent to traditional main stations are extra local FM channels. These
HD2/HD3 Channels provide new, original music as well as deep cuts
into traditional genre.
Press TUNER to switch the input source to “HD Radio”.
GTV ScreenH
HD Radio
STEREO HD-AUTO
Now Playing
CH 1
TUNE+/-
FM 92.10MHz
Tune
CH /
Preset
OPTION
Option
GDisplay of this unitH
01 FM
•HD Radio Technology manufactured under license from iBiquity
Digital Corporation. U.S. and Foreign Patents. HD Radio™ and the HD,
HD Radio, and “Arc” logos are proprietary trademarks of iBiquity Digital
Corp.
For detailed information on HD Radio Technology, please go to
“www.hdradio.com/”.
•For antenna connections, see “Connecting an HD Radio receiver”
(vpage 51).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
71
92.10MHz
2
Press OPTION.
3
Use ui to select “FM/AM”, then press ENTER.
The option menu screen is displayed.
The Band screen is displayed.
Remote
Index
Contents
4
5
Connections
Playback
Settings
FM : W
hen listening to an FM broadcast.
AM : When listening to an AM broadcast.
22Operations available through the OPTION
button
•Tuning in by entering the frequency (Direct Tune) (vpage 73)
•Changing the tuning mode (Tune Mode) (vpage 73)
•Presetting the current broadcast station (Preset Memory)
(vpage 75)
•Tuning in to stations and presetting them automatically
(Auto Preset Memory) (vpage 76)
•Specify a name for the preset broadcast station (Preset Name)
(vpage 76)
•Skipping preset broadcast stations (Preset Skip) (vpage 77)
•Playing the Same Music in All Zones (All Zone Stereo) (vpage 117)
Press TUNE + or TUNE – to select the station you want
to hear.
Scanning is performed until it finds an available radio station. When
it finds a radio station, it stops the scan automatically and tunes in.
%
•The modes for receiving FM broadcasts consists of “Auto” mode that automatically
searches available broadcast stations and “Manual” mode that lets you tune in
using buttons to change the frequency. The default setting is “Auto”. You can also
use “Direct Tune” to tune in by entering the frequency directly.
In “Auto” mode, you cannot tune in to radio stations if the reception is not good. If
this is the case, then use the “Manual” mode or “Direct Tune” to tune in.
0–9
FAVORITE STATION
1–4
Front panel
Function
Tuning (up/down) / Multicast switching
Preset channel selection
Preset channel selection /
Direct frequency tuning
Call up FAVORITE STATION
(Press and hold)
Registering to FAVORITE STATION
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
22Adding to the FAVORITE STATION button
(vpage 105)
Use o p to select “FM” or “AM”, then press ENTER.
Operation buttons
TUNE +, –
CH/PAGE df
Tips
72
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tuning in by entering the frequency
(Direct Tune)
1
2
Use ui to select “Direct Tune”, then press ENTER.
3
Use ui or 0 – 9 to select a number and press p.
4
Repeat step 3 and enter the frequency of the radio
station you want to hear.
5
When setting is completed, press ENTER.
You can change the mode for tuning into FM broadcasts.
The option menu screen is displayed.
The screen that lets you enter the frequency is displayed.
•If o is pressed, the immediately preceding input is cancelled.
The preset frequency is tuned in.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Changing the tuning mode (Tune Mode)
You can enter the receiving frequency directly to tune in.
Press OPTION when the input source is “HD Radio”.
Tips
73
1
Press OPTION when the input source is “HD Radio”.
2
3
Use ui to select “Tune Mode”, then press ENTER.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use o p to select tuning mode, then press ENTER.
Auto : Automatically search for and tune to a receivable radio
station.
HD-Auto : Automatically tune to the HD Radio station.
Analog-Auto : Automatically tune to an analog station and analog
HD Radio station.
Manual : Manually change the frequency one step at a time each
time the button is pressed.
Analog-Manual : Manually tune to an analog station and analog
HD Radio station.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Selecting audio programs
Tips
Listening to preset stations
HD Radio Technology enables stations to broadcast multiple Audio
Program and data services on HD2 / HD3 / HD4 channels.
1
Select the tuning mode (“HD-Auto”, “Auto” or
“Manual”).
2
Press TUNE + or TUNE – to tune in the desired Multicast
channel.
1
Use CH/PAGE df or 0 – 9 to select the desired preset
channel.
•If the station you are tuning in has multiple audio programs,“HD1”is
indicated on the display.
If it only has one audio program, “HD” is indicated.
•When the unit receives multicast channels, the multicast program
number (HD2) is displayed to the right of the station name.
NOTE
•This function is not available for AM HD Radio stations because they cannot
broadcast multicast channels.
•If digital audio data cannot be received after the station is selected, or if the station
signal is weak, the unit may not be able to receive the multicast channels.
•If the station signal is weak, the digital audio of the multicast channel may cut out.
Front panel
Display
Appendix
Rear panel
74
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Presetting the current broadcast station
(Preset Memory)
Channel
Your favorite broadcast stations can be preset so that you can tune them
in easily. Up to 56 stations can be preset.
9 – 16
1
Tune in the broadcast station you want to preset
(vpage 71 “Listening to HD Radio broadcasts”).
17 – 24
2
Press OPTION.
The option menu screen is displayed.
33 – 40
3
Use ui to select “Preset Memory”, then press ENTER.
41 – 48
4
Use ui or 0 – 9 to select the channel you want to
preset, then press ENTER.
1–8
25 – 32
The list of already preset channels is displayed.
49 – 56
Tips
Default settings
92.10 / 92.30 / 92.50 / 92.70 / 93.10 / 93.50 / 93.70 /
94.10 MHz
94.30 / 94.50 / 94.70 / 94.90 / 95.10 / 95.30 / 95.50 /
95.70 MHz
98.10 / 98.30 / 98.50 / 98.70 / 98.90 / 99.10 / 100.10 /
100.30 MHz
100.50 / 100.70 / 100.90 / 101.10 / 101.30 / 101.50 /
101.70 / 101.90 MHz
103.10 / 103.30 / 103.50 / 103.70 / 103.90 / 104.10 /
104.30 / 104.50 MHz
104.70 / 104.90 / 105.10 / 105.30 / 105.50 / 105.70 /
105.90 / 106.10 MHz
106.30 / 106.50 / 106.70 / 106.90 / 107.10 / 107.30 /
107.50 / 107.90 MHz
The current broadcast station that is preset.
•To preset other stations, repeat steps 1 to 4.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
75
Appendix
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tuning in to stations and presetting
them automatically
(Auto Preset Memory)
Press OPTION when the input source is “HD Radio”.
2
Use ui to select “Auto Preset Memory”, then press
ENTER.
3
Press ENTER.
You can set the name to the preset broadcast station or change it.
Up to eight characters can be input.
The option menu screen is displayed.
The unit starts to tune in to radio stations automatically and preset
them.
•When presetting is completed, “Completed” is displayed for
about 5 seconds and the option menu screen turns off.
%
1
Press OPTION when the input source is “HD Radio”.
2
Use ui to select “Preset Name”, then press ENTER.
3
Use o p to select the group of the broadcast station you
want to name.
4
Use ui to select the broadcast station you want to
name, then press ENTER.
5
Use ui to select a name label, then press ENTER.
6
Enter the characters, then press “OK”.
•The preset memory is overwritten.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Specify a name for the preset broadcast
station (Preset Name)
A maximum of 56 radio stations can be automatically preset.
1
Tips
76
The option menu screen is displayed.
The Preset Name screen is displayed.
The screen that lets you edit the preset name is displayed.
•If you select “Set Defaults”, then the unit returns to displaying
the frequency.
•For character input, see page 159.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Skipping preset broadcast stations
(Preset Skip)
Press OPTION when the input source is “HD Radio”.
2
Use ui to select “Preset Skip”, then press ENTER.
3
nn To set the stations you want to skip by groups
Appendix
nn To set the stations you want to skip by
stations
qUse o p to select the group of broadcast stations
you want to skip.
wUse ui to select the broadcast station you want to
skip.
eUse o p to select “Skip”.
When tuning preset broadcast stations, you can set groups or individual
broadcast stations that you don’t want to display in advance.
The preset skip setting is useful when tuning in, because only your favorite
stations are displayed.
1
Tips
The station you selected is not displayed.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Cancelling preset skip
The Preset Skip screen is displayed.
qUse o p to select the group of broadcast stations
you want to skip.
wPress u to select “Set No.z – z to Skip”, then press
ENTER.
All broadcast stations in the group “z – z” you selected are not
displayed.
(z are the selected group numbers)
1
While the Preset Skip screen is displayed, use o p to
select a group containing a broadcast station to cancel
the skip for.
2
Use ui to select a broadcast station to cancel the skip
for.
3
Use o p to select “On”.
The skip is cancelled.
NOTE
•Preset skip cannot be cancelled for groups.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
77
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Check the HD Radio reception
information
1
Tips
%
•If the station signal weakens while receiving a digital broadcast (while “HD” and
text is displayed), the mode automatically switches to the analog reception mode
(the reception frequency is displayed).
Because of this, the “HD” and text may flicker if the station signal level is weak
and unstable.
Press STATUS on the main unit while an HD Radio
broadcast is being received.
The current reception information is shown on the display.
qNormal
w Frequency / Signal strength
e Long station name / Program and Program type
r Title name / Artist name
t Album name / Genre name
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
78
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Listening to Internet Radio
•Internet Radio refers to radio broadcasts distributed over the Internet.
Internet Radio stations from around the world can be received.
•The broad cast station types and specifications supported by this unit for
playback are as follows.
•WMA (Windows Media Audio)
•MP3 (MPEG-1 Audio Layer-3)
•MPEG-4 AAC
NETWORK
INTERNET
RADIO
CH/PAGE df
OPTION
uio p
ENTER
BACK
2
1
HOME
FAVORITE
STATION
1–4
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
79
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Listening to Internet Radio
1
2
3
4
Prepare for playback.
Appendix
Tips
Use ui to select the item you want to play, then press
ENTER.
•Check the network environment, then turn on this unit’s power
(vpage 53 “Connecting to a home network (LAN)”).
Internet Radio
Press NETWORK.
[1/7]
zzzzz
•You can also press INTERNET RADIO to select the input source
“Internet Radio” directly.
Search Stations
Search Podcasts
Recommended Stations
radiomarantz.com
Use uio p to select “Internet Radio”, then press
ENTER.
Recently Played
Search by Keyword
OPTION
Network
Favorites
zzzzz (Country name) :
•Displays typical Internet Radio stations your country.
Search Stations :
•Displays all Internet Radio stations that this unit can tune in to.
Search Podcasts :
•Displays Internet Radio stations in the podcasts that this unit can
tune in to.
Recommended Stations :
•Displays recommended Internet Radio stations.
Internet Radio
Media Server
Spotify
Front panel
Display
Option
Rear panel
80
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
radiomarantz.com :
•Displays Internet Radio stations added to favorites in vTuner. For
instructions on how to add to favorites in vTuner, see “Using
vTuner to add Internet Radio stations to favorites” (vpage 82).
Recently Played :
•Displays recently played Internet Radio stations. Up to 20 stations
can be stored in “Recently Played”.
Search by Keyword :
•Displays Internet Radio stations searched by keyword. For
character input, see page 160.
5
%
NOTE
•The radio station database service may be suspended or be otherwise unavailable
without notice.
Playing the last played Internet Radio
station
1
Playback starts once buffering reaches “100%”.
ENTER
CH/PAGE df
FAVORITE STATION
1–4
INTERNET RADIO
HOME
Front panel
Function
Playback
Stop
(Press and hold)
Stop
Switch to previous page/switch to next
page in the list display
Call up FAVORITE STATION
(Press and hold)
Registering to FAVORITE STATION
Last played Internet Radio station
Go to Home screen
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
•The display switches between track title and radio station name etc. each time the
main unit’s STATUS is pressed.
•Any characters that cannot be displayed are replaced with “.” (period).
Use ui p to select the station, then press ENTER.
Operation buttons
1
2
Tips
81
Press INTERNET RADIO.
The source switches to “Internet Radio” and the last played radio
station plays.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Using vTuner to add Internet Radio
stations to favorites
5
Check the MAC address of this unit (vpage 199
“Information”).
•The MAC address is necessary when you create an account for
vTuner.
2
Use your PC to access the vTuner website (http://www.
radiomarantz.com).
3
4
Enter the MAC address of this unit, then click “Go”.
Display
Rear panel
Select the search criteria (genre, region, language, etc.)
of your choice.
6
Select the radio station of your choice from the list, and
then click the Add to Favorites icon.
7
Enter the name of the favorite group, then click “Go”.
A new favorite group that includes the selected radio station is
created.
•Internet Radio stations added to favorites in vTuner can be played
from “radiomarantz.com” (vpage 81) with this unit.
22Operations available through the OPTION
button
•Registering to Favorites (vpage 112)
•Searching content with keywords (Text Search) (vpage 113)
•Playing back music and a favorite picture at the same time (Slideshow)
(vpage 114)
•Playing the Same Music in All Zones (All Zone Stereo) (vpage 117)
Enter your E-mail address and a password of your
choice.
Front panel
Appendix
•You can also enter a keyword to search for a station you want to
hear.
There are many Internet Radio stations in the world, and this unit can tune
into these stations. But finding the radio station you want to hear may
be difficult, because there are too many stations. If this is the case, then
please use vTuner, an Internet Radio station search website specifically
designed for this unit. You can use your PC to search Internet Radio
stations and add them as your favorites. This unit can play radio stations
added to vTuner.
1
Tips
82
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Playing back files stored on a PC and NAS
•This unit can play back music files and playlists (m3u, wpl) stored on a PC
and on Network Attached Storage (NAS) that supports DLNA.
•The network audio playback function of this unit connects to the server
using technologies shown below.
•Windows Media Player Network Sharing Service
•Windows Media DRM10
•This unit can play back the following files.
•WMA (Windows Media Audio)
•MP3 (MPEG-1 Audio Layer-3)
•WAV
•MPEG-4 AAC
•FLAC (Free Lossless Audio Codec)
•JPEG
•ALAC (Apple Lossless Audio Codec)
NETWORK
CH/PAGE df
OPTION
uio p
ENTER
2
3
1
89
67
BACK
HOME
FAVORITE
STATION
1–4
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
83
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Applying media sharing settings
Here, we apply the settings to share music files stored on a PC and NAS on the network.
If you are using a Media Server, be sure to apply this setting first.
22When using Windows Media Player 12
(Windows 7 / Windows 8)
1
2
3
4
Start up Windows Media Player 12 on the PC.
5
Click “OK” to finish.
22When using Windows Media Player 11
Select “More streaming options...” in the “Stream”.
Select “Allowed” in the drop-down list for “SR7008”.
Select “Allowed” in the drop-down list for “Media
programs on this PC and remote connections...”.
1
2
3
Start up Windows Media Player 11 on the PC.
4
As you did in step 3, select the icon of the device (other
PCs and mobile devices) you want to use as a media
controller, and then click “Allow”.
5
Click “OK” to finish.
Select “Media Sharing” in the “Library”.
Click the “Share my media” check box, select “SR7008”,
and then click “Allow”.
22Sharing media stored in NAS
Change settings on the NAS to allow this unit and other devices (PCs
and mobile devices) used as media controllers to access the NAS. For
details, see the owner’s manual that came with the NAS.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
84
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Playing back files stored on a PC and
NAS
Use this procedure to play music files, image files or playlists.
1
Prepare for playback.
2
3
Press NETWORK.
q Check the network environment, then turn on this unit’s power
(vpage 53 “Connecting to a home network (LAN)”).
w Prepare the computer (vComputer’s operating instructions).
Use ui to select the server including the file to be
played, then press ENTER.
5
Use ui p to select the file, then press ENTER.
Playback starts once buffering reaches “100%”.
6 7
ENTER
Network
Favorites
Internet Radio
ui
Media Server
CH/PAGE df
Spotify
Appendix
4
Operation buttons
1
3
2
8 9
Use uio p to select “Media Server”, then press ENTER.
Tips
FAVORITE STATION 1 – 4
HOME
Function
Playback
Pause
Stop
Skip to previous track/Skip to next track
(Press and hold)
Fast-reverse / Fast-forwardz
Playback / Pause
(Press and hold)
Stop
Skip to previous track/Skip to next track
(Press and hold)
Fast-reverse / Fast-forwardz
Switch to previous page/switch to next
page in the list display
Call up FAVORITE STATION
(Press and hold)
Registering to FAVORITE STATION
Go to Home screen
zz This function is available while an MP3 / WAV / AAC / FLAC file is being played
back.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
85
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
•The display switches between track title, artist name, and album title each time the
main unit’s STATUS is pressed.
•When a WMA (Windows Media Audio), MP3 or MPEG-4 AAC file includes album
art data, the album art can be displayed while the music files are playing.
•If you use Ver.11 or later of Windows Media Player, the album art for WMA files
can be displayed.
•WMA Lossless files can be played when using a server supporting transcoding,
such as Windows Media Player Ver. 11 or later.
•This unit plays back picture (JPEG) files in the order in which they are stored in
the folder.
•Performing repeat playback (vpage 111)
•Performing random playback (vpage 111)
•Registering to Favorites (vpage 112)
•Searching content with keywords (Text Search) (vpage 113)
•Playing back music and a favorite picture at the same time (Slideshow)
(vpage 114)
•Setting the Slideshow Interval (vpage 115)
•Displaying your desired video during audio playback (Video Select)
(vpage 115)
•Adjusting the picture quality for your viewing environment (Picture
Mode) (vpage 116)
•Playing the Same Music in All Zones (All Zone Stereo) (vpage 117)
NOTE
•When playing back music files with your PC or NAS connected through wireless
LAN, audio may be interrupted depending on your wireless LAN environment. In
this case, play back music files with your PC or NAS connected through wired LAN.
•Depending on the size of the still picture (JPEG) file, some time may be required
for the file to be displayed.
•The order in which the tracks/files are displayed depends on the server
specifications. If the tracks/files are not displayed in alphabetical order due to the
server specifications, searching by the first letter may not work properly.
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
22Operations available through the OPTION
button
%
Front panel
Tips
86
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Viewing photographs on the Flickr site
•Flickr is an online photograph sharing service that started in 2004. You
can use the this unit to view photographs that have been made public
by Flickr users. You do not need an account to use Flickr. To view
photographs that you recorded yourself, you need an account in order to
upload these photographs to the Flickr server. For details, see the Flickr
homepage.
http://www.flickr.com/
•You can view photographs shared by particular users, or all of the
photographs shared on Flickr.
NETWORK
CH/PAGE df
OPTION
uio p
ENTER
BACK
2
HOME
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
87
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Viewing photographs shared by
particular users
1
2
3
4
Appendix
Tips
Use ui to select “Add Flickr Contact”, then press
ENTER.
Prepare for playback.
Flickr
•Check the network environment, then turn on this unit’s power
(vpage 53 “Connecting to a home network (LAN)”).
[1/2]
Add Flickr Contact
All Content
Press NETWORK.
Use uio p to select “Flickr”, then press ENTER.
OPTION
Network
Favorites
5
Internet Radio
Option
In “Contact”, add the screen name (user name you want
to view) you want to add.
•For character input, see page 159.
Media Server
Spotify
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
88
6
After inputting the “Contact”, press “OK”.
7
Use ui to select the screen name (user name you want
to view) added to “Contact”, then press ENTER.
The screen name is added to “Contact”, and the screen name you
entered in Step 5 is displayed on the top screen of Flickr.
•If you enter a screen name that does not exist, “The Flickr Contact
you entered could not be found” is displayed. Check and enter the
correct screen name.
Remote
Index
Contents
8
Connections
Playback
Settings
9
Use ui to select the folder, and then press ENTER.
Favorites :
•Displays the favorite photographs of the specified user.
Photostream :
•Displays a list of shared photographs.
PhotoSets :
•Displays the folder (photograph album) list.
Contacts :
•Displays the screen name used by the specified user in Contacts.
Remove this Contact :
•Deletes a user from Flickr Contact.
Add this Contact :
•Adds a user from Flickr Contact.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Tips
Appendix
Use ui p to select the photograph, and then press
ENTER.
The selected photograph is displayed.
Operation buttons
ENTER
2
ui
CH/PAGE df
HOME
89
Remote
Function
Playback
(Press and hold)
Stop
Stop
Display previous photograph/display next
photograph
Switch to previous page/switch to next
page in the list display
Go to Home screen
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Viewing all photographs on Flickr
1
NOTE
22Operations available through the OPTION
button
•Setting the Slideshow Interval (vpage 115)
•Displaying your desired video during audio playback (Video Select)
(vpage 115)
•Adjusting the picture quality for your viewing environment (Picture
Mode) (vpage 116)
•Playing the Same Music in All Zones (All Zone Stereo) (vpage 117)
[1/2]
Add Flickr Contact
All Content
OPTION
Option
2
Use ui to select the folder, and then press ENTER.
3
Use ui p to select the photograph, and then press
ENTER.
Interestingness :
•Displays photographs that are popular from the number of user
comments or number of times they are added as favorites.
Recent :
•Displays the most recently added photographs.
Search by text :
•Search for photographs by keyword.
The selected photograph is displayed.
Front panel
Display
Appendix
•Depending on the file format, some photographs may not be viewable.
Use ui to select “All Content”, then press ENTER.
Flickr
Tips
Rear panel
90
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Listening to Pandora®
Pandora is an automated music recommendation and Internet Radio
service created by the Music Genome Project.
To listen to Pandora you will need a free Pandora account. If you do not
have a Pandora account, you can create one at www.pandora.com or from
the Pandora smartphone application.
It is necessary to associate this machine with a Pandora account by visiting
http://www.pandora.com/marantz from your PC.
NETWORK
CH/PAGE df
OPTION
uio p
ENTER
BACK
2
3
1
9
HOME
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
91
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Listening to Pandora®
1
Prepare for playback.
2
3
Press NETWORK.
4
Appendix
If you have a Pandora account, use ui to select “I have
a Pandora account”, then press ENTER.
•If you do not have a Pandora account, press i to select “I am
new to Pandora”. The URL of Pandora and activation code are
displayed. Access the Pandora web page from your PC and
register the displayed activation code and account information.
Then press ENTER.
q Check the network environment, then turn on this unit’s power
(vpage 53 “Connecting to a home network (LAN)”).
w Complete step 4 and obtain a Pandora account.
•If you already have a Pandora account, you do not need to
obtain a new account. Use your existing Pandora account.
Pandora
I have a Pandora account
Use uio p to select “Pandora”, then press ENTER.
I am new to Pandora
Please go to
http://www.pandora.com/marantz and follow
the instructions there to create a new account.
Network
Favorites
Your activation code is : zzzzzz
BACK
Internet Radio
Spotify
Display
Cancel
Continue
This is an identification code required to register your
purchased product to the Pandora service.
This code is used to obtain your account.
Media Server
Front panel
Tips
Rear panel
92
Remote
Index
Contents
5
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
Creating a new station
Input “Email address” and “Password”.
You can create up to 100 radio stations.
Pandora Account
1
Email address
Use ui to select “New Station”, then press ENTER.
Password
My Station
[1/4]
New Station
OK
Quick Mix
Music1 Radio
Exit
Enter Email address
BACK
Sign Out
•For character input, see page 159.
•Press BACK to cancel the input. When “Cancel Input?” is
displayed, select “Yes”, then press ENTER.
6
After inputting the “Email address” and “Password”,
select “OK”, then press ENTER.
2
Input a track or artist name, then press “OK”.
If the “Email address” and “Password” match, the top menu for
Pandora is displayed.
New Station
Track or Artist
Clear
Music2
Insert
K
L M
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
!
“
F G H
S
T U V W X Y
(
)
* +
a/A
Select
Cancel
‘
Space
Rear panel
93
Remote
,
Cancel
Input
•For character input, see page 159.
Display
I
N O P Q R
$ % &
BACK
Delete
J
A B C D E
Front panel
Option
OPTION
Index
;
Z
#
< = >
OK
Contents
3
Connections
Playback
Settings
Operation buttons
1
3
2
9
Use ui to select “Search by Artist” or “Search by
Track”, then press ENTER.
You can search and display a list by track or artist.
New Station
Track or Artist
Clear
Music2
Insert
ENTER
Delete
H I J K L M
E F G
A B C D Search
by Artist
N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z
Search by Track
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
$ % &
‘
a/A
BACK
4
(
* +
)
Space
Select
Cancel
,
;
“
!
i
#
< = >
Cancel
CH/PAGE df
OK
HOME
Input
•You can create up to 100 Stations (radio stations).
•Your new station will play music with similar qualities to the artist or track
you entered.
“Radio” is added to the end of a filename, and your new station is
created (e.g. Music2 Radio).
[4/5]
New Station
Quick Mix
Music1 Radio
Music2 Radio
Sign Out
OPTION
Front panel
Display
Option
Rear panel
Appendix
Function
Playback
Pause
Stop
Skip to next track
Playback / Pause
(Press and hold)
Stop
Skip to next track
Switch to previous page/switch to
next page in the list display
Go to Home screen
%
Press ui, select a file (e.g. Music2 Radio) from the list,
and press ENTER.
My Station
Tips
94
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Listening to an existing station
1
Tips
Listening to created radio stations at
random
Use ui and select the radio station (“Music2 Radio”)
that you want to listen to, and press ENTER.
1
Music2 Radio
Use ui to select “Quick Mix”, then press ENTER.
Created radio stations are selected at random, and tracks are
streamed.
Now Playing
Title
Artist
Album
00:06
100%
Pause
Back
OPTION
Next
Option
Menu
%
•You can Skip up to 6 Tracks that are being played back within 1 hour.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
95
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Giving Feedback and Managing Stations
Press p while a track is playing.
The Pandora menu screen is displayed.
Menu
[1/8]
I like this track
I don’t like this track
Why is this track playing?
Create station
Bookmark this artist
Bookmark this track
I’m tired of this track
%
•You can create up to 100 Stations (radio stations).
I like this track :
•Press when you like the track that is being played.
•It will return to the Play Screen. And
(Thumbs up) icon is
displayed. (The icon is not displayed on the next track.)
I don’t like this track :
•Press when you don’t like the track that is being played.
(Thumbs down) icon is
•It will return to the Play Screen. And
displayed. (The icon is not displayed on the next track.)
Why is this track playing? :
•Displays the reason why Pandora selected this track.
Create station :
•Creates a Station for the Track or Artist being played.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Bookmark this artist :
•Bookmarks the artist currently being played.
•You can check on a computer or iPhone etc.
•For details, see the Pandora web page.
Bookmark this track :
•Bookmarks the track currently being played.
•You can check on a computer or iPhone etc.
•For details, see the Pandora web page.
I’m tired of this track :
•Press when you don’t like the track that is being played.
•The track will not be played for 1 month.
Delete this station :
•Press when you want to delete the station that is being played.
You can personalize your stations by providing feedback.
1
Tips
96
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Disassociate this unit from your Pandora account.
•Displaying your desired video during audio playback (Video Select)
(vpage 115)
•Adjusting the picture quality for your viewing environment (Picture
Mode) (vpage 116)
•Playing the Same Music in All Zones (All Zone Stereo) (vpage 117)
Use ui to select “Sign Out”, then press ENTER.
My Station
[4/4]
New Station
Quick Mix
Are you sure you want to sign out
D&M1 Radio
xxxxx_xxxxxxx@dm-holdings.com?
Yes
No
OPTION
2
Option
When the popup menu appears, use o p to select “Yes”,
then press ENTER.
Front panel
Display
Appendix
22Operations available through the OPTION
button
Sign Out
1
Tips
Rear panel
97
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Listening to SiriusXM Internet Radio
Enjoy anywhere access to the unparalleled content of SiriusXM.
Whether on your computer, smartphone, tablet, Lynx Portable Enjoy
anywhere access to the unparalleled content of SiriusXM.
Whether on your computer, smartphone, tablet, Lynx Portable Radio,
or compatible Internet-connected device, you don’t need to be in your
vehicle to enjoy SiriusXM.
For details, see the SiriusXM homepage.
http://www.siriusxm.com
Listening to SiriusXM Internet Radio
NETWORK
Over 120-channels of the SiriusXM programming you love, including
commercial-free music plus sports, talk, news and entertainment.
Listen anywhere on your computer or smartphone.
CH/PAGE df
OPTION
uio p
ENTER
BACK
Prepare for playback.
2
Press NETWORK.
2
1
HOME
Front panel
1
Display
Rear panel
98
q Check the network environment, then turn on this unit’s power
(vpage 53 “Connecting to a home network (LAN)”).
wAccess the following website from your PC and obtain a
SiriusXM account.
http://www.siriusxm.com
•If you already have a SiriusXM account, you do not need to
obtain a new account. Select “Sign in” in step 4, and enter
your existing SiriusXM account.
Remote
Index
Contents
3
Connections
Playback
Settings
5
Use uio p to select “SiriusXM”, then press ENTER.
Appendix
Tips
Input the “Username” and “Password”.
SiriusXM Sign in
Network
Favorites
Internet Radio
Username
zzzzz
Password
zzzzz
Media Server
Spotify
Sign in
BACK
4
Select “Sign in”, then press ENTER.
Exit
Enter
•For character input, see page 159.
SiriusXM Sign in
Please set your SiriusXM username and password.
You can go to www.siriusxm.com to sign up
for an account. Or,select “Start Trial” below
to start the one-time free trial.
6
Select the “Sign in”, and then press ENTER.
7
8
Use ui to select the genre, then press ENTER.
The top menu of SiriusXM is displayed.
Use ui to select the file, and then press ENTER.
The selected file is displayed.
Sign in
Start Trial
BACK
Front panel
Cancel
Enter
Display
Rear panel
99
Remote
Index
Contents
Operation buttons
1
2
ENTER
CH/PAGE df
HOME
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
22Operations available through the OPTION
button
Function
Playback
Stop
Playback
(Press and hold)
Stop
Switch to previous page/switch to next
page in the list display
Go to Home screen
•Displaying your desired video during audio playback (Video Select)
(vpage 115)
•Adjusting the picture quality for your viewing environment (Picture
Mode) (vpage 116)
•Playing the Same Music in All Zones (All Zone Stereo) (vpage 117)
Sign Out
Disassociate this unit from your SiriusXM account.
1
2
Use ui to select “Sign Out”, then press ENTER.
When the popup menu appears, use o p to select “Yes”,
then press ENTER.
SiriusXM
[23/23]
Religion
Rock
Are
you sure you want to sign out?
Are you sure you want to sign out
Dance/Electronic
xxxxxxx?
Hip-Hop/R&B
Yes
Country
Yes
Account Info
No
No
Sign Out
OPTION
Front panel
Display
Option
Rear panel
Appendix
100
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
Listening to Spotify
Introduce your Marantz to a whole new world of music. With Spotify, you
can enjoy instant access to millions of songs.
A Spotify Premium subscription is required.
For details, see the Spotify homepage.
http://www.spotify.com
Listening to Spotify
NETWORK
1
Prepare for playback.
2
3
Press NETWORK.
CH/PAGE df
OPTION
uio p
ENTER
BACK
2
3
1
89
67
HOME
q Check the network environment, then turn on this unit’s power
(vpage 53 “Connecting to a home network (LAN)”).
w Complete step 5 and obtain a Spotify account.
•If you already have a Spotify account, you do not need to obtain
a new account. Use your existing Spotify account.
Use uio p to select “Spotify”, then press ENTER.
Network
Favorites
Internet Radio
Media Server
Spotify
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
101
Remote
Index
Contents
4
Connections
Playback
Settings
If you have a Spotify account, then press ENTER.
GUpper case characters/Numbers/SymbolsH
ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
ÄÀÁÂÃÅÆÇÐÈÉÊËÌÍÎÏÑÖÒÓÔÕØÜÙÚÛÝÞ
0123456789
!“#$%&’()z+,;<=>
GLower case characters/Numbers/SymbolsH
abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz
äàáâãåæçðèéêëìíîïñöòóôõøüùúûýþÿß
0123456789
.@-_/:˜?[\]^’{|}
Introduce your Marantz to a whole new world
of music. With Spotify, you can enjoy instant
access to millions of songs.
A Spotify Premium subscription is required.
Just subscribe at spotify.com
Get Started
5
Exit
Use ui p to enter your username and password.
•The password should be no longer than 99 characters.
•Press BACK to cancel the input. When “Cancel Input?” is
displayed, select “Yes”, then press ENTER.
Spotify Log In
Username
zzzzz
Password
zzzzz
Log In
BACK
Front panel
Exit
Enter
Display
Appendix
•For character input, see page 159.
The types of characters that can be input are as shown below.
Spotify
BACK
Tips
Rear panel
102
Remote
Index
Contents
6
Connections
Playback
Settings
8
After inputting the username and password, select “Log
In”, then press ENTER.
If the username and password match, the top menu for Spotify is
displayed.
7
Appendix
Tips
Use ui to select a station, and press ENTER to start
playback.
Playback starts and the following screen appears.
Spotify
Use ui to select menu and then press ENTER.
Now Playing
Spotify
Title
Artist
Album
[1/5]
Search
00:06
What’s New
Starred
Playlists
Pause
Back
Accounts
OPTION
Operation buttons
1
3
2
8 9
Option
Search :
•Searches for tracks, artists and albums by entering keywords.
What’s New :
•Displays the list of the latest albums.
Starred :
•Displays the list of the starred tracks.
Playlists :
•Displays the playlists for Spotify.
Accounts :
•Manages accounts (Log out, Add new user, Switch to user).
6 7
ENTER
ui
CH/PAGE df
HOME
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
103
Remote
Previous
Next
OPTION
Option
Menu
Function
Playback
Pause
Stop
Skip to previous track/Skip to next track
(Press and hold)
Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
Playback / Pause
(Press and hold)
Stop
Skip to previous track/Skip to next track
(Press and hold)
Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
Switch to previous page/switch to next
page in the list display
Go to Home screen
Index
Contents
9
Connections
Playback
Settings
Press p while a track is playing.
•The display switches between track title, artist name, and album title each time the
main unit’s STATUS is pressed.
22Operations available through the OPTION
button
[1/3]
Star this track
•Performing repeat playback (vpage 111)
•Performing random playback (vpage 111)
•Displaying your desired video during audio playback (Video Select)
(vpage 115)
•Adjusting the picture quality for your viewing environment (Picture
Mode) (vpage 116)
•Playing the Same Music in All Zones (All Zone Stereo) (vpage 117)
Browse “Artist name”
Browse “Album name”
Back
Star this track :
•Adds a star to the selected track.
Browse “Artist name” :
•Displays the list of albums by the artist of the track that is being
played back.
Browse “Album name” :
•Displays the list of tracks on the album that is being played back.
Front panel
Display
Appendix
%
The Spotify menu screen is displayed.
Track-Artist
Tips
Rear panel
104
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Adding to the FAVORITE STATION button
With a single press of these, you can call up registered radio stations and
contents.
You can add up to four types of content.
1
Press and hold one of the FAVORITE STATION 1 – 4
buttons for 3 seconds or longer while playing back a
content or listening to a radio station.
The content you are playing back or the radio station you are
listening to is registered to the pressed button.
•Contents that can be added to the FAVORITE STATION button
differ depending on the input source.
Input source
HD Radio
FAVORITE
STATION
1–4
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Internet Radio
Top list of content / Internet Radio station
Media Server
Top list of content / Track of Media Server
Flickr
Top list of content
Pandora
Top list of content
SiriusXM
Top list of content
Spotify
Top list of content
Favorites
105
Contents that can be added
Radio station
Remote
Top list of content / Internet Radio station /
Track of Media Server
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Playing back content added to the
FAVORITE STATION button
You can easily call up content by pressing the FAVORITE STATION button.
1
Press one of the FAVORITE STATION 1 – 4 buttons that
you added content to.
Playback starts.
%
•Internet Radio stations are already registered to the FAVORITE STATION 1 – 4
buttons. However, you may not be able to play the stations due to restrictions
imposed by the radio stations.
NOTE
•The following operations update the database on the Media Server, which may
make the added music files unplayable.
•When you quit the Media Server and then restart it.
•When music files are deleted or added on the Media Server.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
106
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
AirPlay function
Music files stored on your iPhone, iPod touch, iPad or iTunes can be
played on this unit via the network.
Playing songs from your iPhone, iPod
touch or iPad
PC
If you update your “iPhone/iPod touch/iPad” to iOS 4.2.1 or later, you can
stream music stored in your “iPhone/iPod touch/iPad” directly to this unit.
This unit
1
Router
Connect your iPhone, iPod touch or iPad Wi-Fi to the
same network as this unit.
•For details, see your device’s manual.
2
Play the song on your iPhone, iPod touch or iPad.
' is displayed on the iPhone, iPod touch or iPad screen.
3
4
Tap the AirPlay icon '.
Select the speaker you want to use.
Marantz SR7008
Cancel
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
107
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Playing iTunes music with this unit
1
Install iTunes 10, or later, on a Mac or Windows PC that
is connected to the same network as this unit.
2
Turn this unit ON.
Selecting multiple speakers (devices)
It is possible to play iTunes songs on your home’s AirPlay compatible
speakers (devices) other than those of this unit.
1
2
Set “IP Control” (vpage 199) to “Always On” for this unit.
NOTE
Click the AirPlay icon ' and select “Multiple”.
Check the speakers you want to use.
•When “IP Control” is set to “Always On”, the unit consumes more standby
power.
3
Appendix
Tips
AirPlay
Single
Multiple
Master Volume
Launch iTunes and click the AirPlay icon ' displayed
the window and select this unit from the list.
My Computer
Marantz SR7008
4
NOTE
Choose a song and click play in iTunes.
•In playback using the AirPlay function, the sound is output at the iPhone, iPod
touch, iPad or iTunes volume setting level.
You should turn down the iPhone, iPod touch, iPad or iTunes volume prior to
playback and then adjust it to a suitable level.
The music will stream to this unit.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
108
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Perform iTunes playback operations
with the remote control unit of this unit
Devices Preferences
General
With this unit’s remote control unit, you can perform iTunes song play,
pause, and auto search (cue) operations.
1
2
3
Appendix
Tips
Playback
Sharing
Store
Parental
Devices
Advanced
Device backups:
Select “Edit” – “Preferences...” on the menu.
Select “Devices” in the iTunes setting window.
Delete Backup ...
Check “Allow iTunes audio control from remote
speakers”, and then click “OK”.
Prevent iPods, iPhones, and iPads from syncing automatically
Warn when
more than 5%
of the data on this computer will be changed
Allow iTunes audio control from remote speakers
Only allow paired or Home Sharing Remotes to control iTunes
%
iTunes is not paired with any Remotes
•
is displayed on the menu screen while AirPlay is being operated.
•Source input will be switched to “NETWORK” when AirPlay playback is started.
•You can stop AirPlay playback by pressing the o or choosing other input source.
•To see song and artist names together, press STATUS on the main unit.
•For information about how to use iTunes, also see the Help for iTunes.
•The screen may differ depending on the OS and software versions.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Forget All Remotes
Reset Sync History
?
109
Remote
OK
Index
Cancel
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Convenience functions
This section explains how to use convenient functions that can be used
for each input source.
ZONE SELECT
NETWORK
OPTION
uio p
ENTER
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
110
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Performing repeat playback
Tips
Appendix
Performing random playback
nn Supported input sources : USB / Media Server / Spotify
nn Supported input sources : USB / Media Server / Spotify
1
While content is playing, press OPTION.
1
While content is playing, press OPTION.
2
3
Use ui to select “Repeat”, then press ENTER.
2
3
Use ui to select “Random”, then press ENTER.
4
Press ENTER.
4
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use o p to select repeat playback mode.
Off (Default) : R
epeat playback mode is canceled.
One : A
file being played is played repeatedly.
All : All files in the folder currently being played are played
repeatedly.
Press ENTER.
Display
Use o p to select random playback mode.
Off (Default) : Disable random playback.
On : Randomly play back all tracks in the current playback folder.
The display returns to the playback screen.
%
The display returns to the playback screen.
Front panel
The option menu screen is displayed.
•During random playback, each time playback of a track is completed, another track
is randomly selected for playback from tracks in the folder. Therefore, it’s possible
that you may hear a track played back more than once during random playback.
Rear panel
111
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Registering to Favorites
Playing back content added in “Save to
Favorites”
You can add up to 100 items as favorites for Internet Radio and Media
Server.
1
2
nn Supported input sources : Internet Radio / Media Server
1
While content is playing, press OPTION.
2
Use ui to select “Save to Favorites”, then press ENTER.
Appendix
Tips
The option menu screen is displayed.
Press NETWORK.
Use uio p to select “Favorites”, then press ENTER.
Network
“Favorite added” is displayed, and the current content is added to
favorites.
•The display returns to the playback screen when the procedure
is completed.
Favorites
Internet Radio
Media Server
Spotify
3
Use ui to select the content you want to play, and
then press ENTER.
Playback starts.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
112
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Deleting content added to favorites
1
2
3
4
Tips
Appendix
Searching content with keywords
(Text Search)
Press NETWORK.
nn Supported input sources : USB / Internet Radio / Media Server
Use uio p to select “Favorites”, then press ENTER.
1
While the list is displayed, press OPTION.
The option menu screen is displayed.
2
Use ui to select “Text Search”, then press ENTER.
Use ui to select “Remove from Favorites”, then press
ENTER.
3
Enter the first character of the Internet Radio station or
file you want to search for, and then press “OK”.
Use ui to select the content you want to delete from
favorites, then press OPTION.
“Favorite removed” is displayed, and the selected content is
deleted from favorites.
•The display returns to the original screen when the procedure is
completed.
The option menu screen is displayed.
The keyboard input screen is displayed.
•For character input, see page 159.
4
Use ui to select the content you want to play, and
then press ENTER.
Playback starts.
%
•“Text Search” searches for Internet Radio stations or files that start with the
entered first character from the displayed list.
NOTE
•“Text Search” may not work for some lists.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
113
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Playing back music and a favorite picture at the same time (Slideshow)
nn Supported input sources : USB
nn Supported input sources : Internet Radio / Media Server
1
Play back a still picture.
1
Play back a still picture.
2
3
Play back a music file (vpage 68).
2
Play back a music file of Media Server or Internet Radio
station (vpage 80, 85).
Press OPTION.
3
Press OPTION.
4
Use ui to select “Slideshow”, then press ENTER.
4
Use ui to select “Slideshow”, then press ENTER.
•Playing back still pictures stored on USB memory devices
(vpage 68).
The option menu screen is displayed.
The option menu disappears, and the picture you were viewing is
shown on the screen.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
114
•Playing back still pictures stored on Media Server (vpage 83).
•Playing back still pictures stored on Flickr (vpage 87).
The option menu screen is displayed.
The option menu disappears, and the picture you were viewing is
shown on the screen.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Setting the Slideshow Interval
Tips
Appendix
Displaying your desired video during
audio playback (Video Select)
Set the playback interval when playing back a slideshow of still image
(JPEG) files stored on a USB memory stick or media server, or on the
Flickr website.
nn Supported input sources : USB / Media Server / Flickr
This unit can display video from a different source on TV during audio
playback.
You can set this for each input source.
1
While the list is displayed, press OPTION.
nn Supported input sources : iPod/USB / CDz / HD  Radio / NETWORK /
PHONO / M-XPort
2
Use ui to select “Slideshow Interval”, then press
ENTER.
3
Use o p to set the display time.
4
The option menu screen is displayed.
zz Available when none of HDMI, component video or video connector is
assigned.
Off : T
he slide show is not played back.
5s (Default) – 60s : Set the time for displaying a single picture when
playing back images in the slide show.
1
Press OPTION during audio playback.
2
3
Use ui to select “Video Select”, then press ENTER.
4
If you selected “On” in step 3, press i and select
“Source”.
5
Press o p to select the input source for video you want
to play back, and press ENTER.
Press ENTER.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
115
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use o p to select the Video Select mode.
Off (Default) : Disable Video Select mode.
On : Enable Video Select mode.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Adjusting the picture quality for your
viewing environment (Picture Mode)
3
Use o p to select picture mode.
4
Press ENTER.
nn Supported input sources : CBL/SAT / DVD / Blu-ray / GAME/
AUX1 / AUX2 / MEDIA PLAYER / iPod/USB / NETWORK / CDz /
TV AUDIOz
zz You can set the picture mode when an HDMI, component video or video
connector is assigned.
1
Press OPTION during video playback.
2
Use ui to select “Picture Mode”, then press ENTER.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
116
Tips
Appendix
Off : No picture quality adjustment is done with this unit.
Standard : The standard mode suited for most living room viewing
environments.
Movie : A mode suited for watching movies in a dark room such as
a theater room.
Vivid : A mode that makes graphic images for games, etc. brighter
and more vivid.
Streaming : A mode suited for low bit rate video sources.
Custom : Adjusts the picture quality manually.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
You can play back music in another room (ZONE2/ZONE3) simultaneously
that is played back in MAIN ZONE.
It is useful when you want to enjoy the same music at the same time
in multiple rooms during home party or when you want to play back the
same BGM in the entire house.
Turn on the power for the multi-zones (ZONE2/ZONE3)
that you want to playback using All Zone Stereo mode
in advance.
2
3
Press ZONE SELECT to switch “MAIN”.
4
5
Use ui to select “All Zone Stereo”, then press ENTER.
1
During playback in All Zone Stereo mode, press OPTION.
2
3
Use ui to select “All Zone Stereo”, then press ENTER.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use o p to select “Off”, then press ENTER.
%
•The All Zone Stereo mode is also stopped when you:
•Turn MAIN ZONE off.
•Change the input source for MAIN ZONE.
•Change the sound mode.
•When “HDMI Audio Out” (vpage 173) is set to “TV”, the All Zone Stereo mode
is not available.
•When “Input Mode” (vpage 182) is set to other than “7.1CH IN”, the All Zone
Stereo mode is available.
Press OPTION.
The option menu screen is displayed.
Use o p to select “On”, then press ENTER.
The input source for the multi-zones (ZONE2/ZONE3) is switched to
the same as the one for MAIN ZONE, and playback in the All Zone
Stereo mode starts.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
22Stopping the All Zone Stereo mode
Playing the Same Music in All Zones
(All Zone Stereo)
1
Tips
117
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Selecting a sound mode
This unit allows you to enjoy various kinds of surround and stereo playback
modes.
Multi-channel audio formats are provided on popular movie and music disc
formats such as Blu-ray and DVD, as well as being supported by digital
broadcasting, and even by streaming movies and music from internetbased subscription services.
This unit supports playback of almost all of these multi-channel audio
formats. It also supports surround playback of audio formats other than
multi-channel audio such as 2-channel stereo audio.
%
•For audio formats recorded on a disc, see the disc jacket or label.
ui
PURE
GAME
MOVIE
MUSIC
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
118
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
22Switching the sound mode
Selecting a sound mode
1
Tips
•Press and hold MOVIE, MUSIC or GAME displays a list of the sound
modes that can be selected. Each time you press MOVIE, MUSIC or
GAME, the sound mode changes.
•While the list is displayed, you can also use ui to select a sound
mode.
•Try out various sound modes and enjoy sound mode in your favorite
mode.
Press MOVIE, MUSIC or GAME to select a sound mode.
MOVIE : Switches to the sound mode suitable for enjoying movies
and TV programs.
MUSIC : S
witches to the sound mode suitable for enjoying music.
GAME : S
witches to the sound mode suitable for enjoying games.
%
GExampleH When MOVIE is pressed and held
•The MOVIE, MUSIC, or GAME button memorizes the last sound mode selected for
its button. Pressing MOVIE, MUSIC, or GAME recalls the same sound mode as the
one selected at the previous playback.
•If the content played back does not support the previously selected sound mode,
the most appropriate sound mode for the content is automatically selected.
•This can be set by pressing MOVIE, MUSIC or GAME on the main unit.
MOVIE SOUND
STEREO
DOLBY PLIIx MOVIE
DTS NEO:X CINEMA
MULTI CH STEREO
VIRTUAL
%
•You can also press SOUND MODE on the unit to switch the sound mode.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
119
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Direct playback
Appendix
Pure Direct playback
Sound recorded in source is played as is.
1
Tips
This mode is for playback with higher sound quality than in “DIRECT”
mode, by turning off the front panel display panel, which can eliminate
faint low level noise from creeping into sensitive analog circuitry.
Press PURE to select “DIRECT”.
Direct playback begins.
1
%
•While DSD signals are played back, “DSD DIRECT” is displayed.
•This can be set by pressing PURE DIRECT on the main unit.
Press PURE to select “PURE DIRECT”.
The display goes dark, and Pure Direct playback begins.
The PURE DIRECT indicator lights.
%
•In DIRECT and PURE DIRECT sound modes, the following items cannot be
adjusted.
•Tone (vpage 165)
•M-DAX (vpage 165)
•MultEQ® XT32 (vpage 167)
•Dynamic EQ (vpage 168)
•Dynamic Volume (vpage 169)
•Audyssey LFC™ (vpage 169)
•This can be set by pressing PURE DIRECT on the main unit.
NOTE
•Video signals are only output when HDMI signals are played in the PURE DIRECT
mode.
•When the PURE DIRECT mode has been selected, the display turns off after about
5 seconds.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
120
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Auto surround playback
This mode detects the type of input digital signal, and automatically
selects the corresponding mode for playback.
1
Press PURE to select “AUTO”.
Auto surround playback begins.
%
•This can be set by pressing PURE DIRECT on the main unit.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
121
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22Description of sound mode types
Dolby sound mode
Sound mode type
DOLBY PLgxz1
DOLBY PLg
DOLBY PLgzz2
DOLBY DIGITAL
DOLBY DIGITAL EXz1
DOLBY TrueHD
DOLBY DIGITAL Plus
Description
This mode can be selected when the Dolby Pro Logic gx decoder is used to play back 2-channel sources in 6.1/7.1-channel
surround sound including the surround back channel(s).
By adding the surround back channel(s), a more enveloping surround environment is produced, compared to Dolby Pro
Logic g.
There are three playback modes: “Movie” mode that is optimized for movie playback, “Music” mode that is optimized
for music playback, and “Game” mode that is optimized for game play.
This mode can be selected when the Dolby Pro Logic g decoder is used to play back 2-channel sources in 5.1-channel
surround sound with an enveloping surround sound experience.
This mode can be selected when the Dolby Pro Logic gz decoder is used to play back 2-channel sources in 7.1-channel
surround sound with added front height channels.
By adding front height channels, the front soundstage becomes dramatically taller, simulating the effect of listening in
a large movie theater or concert hall.
This mode can be selected when playing sources recorded with Dolby Digital.
Using the Dolby Digital EX decoder, this mode plays Dolby Digital sources in 6.1/7.1-channel surround sound with added
surround back channel(s).
By adding surround back speaker(s), sounds can be heard coming at you from behind and not just from the sides.
This mode can be selected when playing sources recorded in Dolby TrueHD.
This mode can be selected when playing sources recorded with Dolby Digital Plus.
z1 This can be selected when “Speaker Config.” – “Surr. Back” (vpage 194) is not set to “None”.
z2 This can be selected when “Speaker Config.” – “Front Height” (vpage 195) is not set to “None”.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
122
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
DTS sound mode
Sound mode type
DTS NEO:Xz1
DTS SURROUND
DTS ES DSCRT6.1z2
DTS ES MTRX6.1z3
DTS 96/24
DTS-HD
DTS Express
Description
This matrix decoding technology uses the DTS NEO:X decoder to playback 2-channel source or 5.1/6.1/7.1-channel
surround sound including the surround back channel.
There are 3 modes: “Music” suited for playing music, “Cinema” suited for playing movies, and “Game” which is
optimized for playing games.
This mode can be selected when playing sources recorded in DTS.
This mode is suitable for playing discs recorded in DTS-ES. The surround back channel added using the discrete method
is played as an independent channel.
Since all channels are independent, the 360-degree spacial expressiveness and sound localization are enhanced.
This mode is suitable for playing discs recorded in DTS-ES.
The surround back channel added to the surround-left and surround-right channels by a matrix encoder at software
recording time is decoded by this unit’s matrix decoder and played from each channel (surround left, surround right,
surround back).
This mode can be selected when playing sources recorded in DTS 96/24.
This mode can be selected when playing sources recorded in DTS-HD.
This mode can be selected when playing sources recorded in DTS Express.
z1 This mode cannot be selected when DSD signals from Super Audio CD are input.
z2 This mode can be selected when only one surround back speaker is used and no front height speaker is used.
z3 This can be selected when “Speaker Config.” – “Surr. Back” (vpage 194) is set other than to “1 spkr”.
PCM multi-channel sound mode
Sound mode type
MULTI CH IN
Front panel
Description
This mode can be selected when playing multi-channel PCM/DSD sources.
Display
Rear panel
123
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Audyssey DSX® sound mode
Sound mode type
Audyssey DSX®
(A-DSX)z
Description
This mode creates playback for the new channels (front wide or front height) in 5.1-channel systems. By adding front
wide or front height channels, the surround sound effects sound become more three dimensional and realistic.
zz This can be selected when a setting other than “None” is selected for “Front Height” or “Front Wide”, and a setting other than “None” is selected for “Center” in
“Speaker Config.” (vpage 193).
Original sound mode
Sound mode type
MULTI CH STEREO
VIRTUAL
Description
This mode is for enjoying stereo sound from all speakers.
Stereo audio (2-channel) sources are played back via the front (L/R) speakers, the surround speakers and if connected
the surround back speakers.
This mode lets you experience an expansive surround sound effect when playing back through just the front (L/R)
speakers only, and when listening with stereo headphones.
AUTO sound mode
Sound mode type
AUTO
Front panel
Description
In this mode, the type of digital signal input, such as Dolby Digital, Dolby TrueHD, Dolby Digital Plus, DTS, DTS-HD,
PCM (multi-channel) is detected, and the playback mode switches automatically to the corresponding mode.
If the input signal is analog or PCM (2-channel), stereo playback is used.
Display
Rear panel
124
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Stereo sound mode
Sound mode type
STEREO
Description
This mode plays 2-channel stereo audio with no additional surround sound processing.
•Sound is output from the front left and right speakers, and subwoofer if connected.
•When multi-channel signals are inputted, they are mixed down to 2-channel audio and are played back with no
additional surround sound processing.
Direct sound mode
Sound mode type
DIRECT
PURE DIRECT
Front panel
Description
This mode provides a direct input-to-output path with minimal audio processing, bypassing any unnecessary stages for
purest sound.
This mode provides the direct audio signal path benefit of the Direct mode along with disabling additional stages that
might possibly have an affect on sound quality.
In Pure Direct mode, the following elements are turned off:
•The front panel display and its driver circuitry are shut down. The display will temporarily come on when adjusting the
volume, etc., but will turn off again once the adjustment has been made.
•The analog video input/output switcher and processor is disabled.
Display
Rear panel
125
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
22Sound mode
•The following sound modes can be selected using the MOVIE, MUSIC, GAME, and PURE buttons.
•Adjust the sound field effect with the menu “Surround Parameter” (vpage 162) to enjoy surround sound the way you like it.
Input signal
Sound mode
Note
STEREO
MOVIE
Sound mode
MUSIC
GAME
S
S
S
DOLBY PLg/gx Movie
z2
S
DOLBY PLg/gx Music
z2
S
DOLBY PLg/gx Game
z2
S
DOLBY PLg/gx Movie A-DSX
z2
S
DOLBY PLg/gx Music A-DSX
z2
S
2-channel z1
DOLBY PLg/gx Game A-DSX
z2
S
DOLBY PLgz
z2
S
S
S
DTS NEO:X Cinema
z2 z3
S
DTS NEO:X Music
z2 z3
S
DTS NEO:X Game
z2 z3
S
MULTI CH STEREO
S
S
S
VIRTUAL
S
S
S
z1 2-channel also includes analog input.
z2 This mode plays back 2-channel sources in 5.1 or 7.1-channel playback. It cannot be selected when headphones are used, or when only front speakers are used.
z3 This mode cannot be selected when DSD signals from Super Audio CD are input.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
126
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Input signal
Multi-channel z4
Dolby Digital
Dolby TrueHD
Playback
Settings
Sound mode
Note
STEREO
DOLBY DIGITAL
DOLBY DIGITAL EX
DOLBY DIGITAL + PLgx Movie
DOLBY DIGITAL + PLgx Music
DOLBY DIGITAL + PLgz
DOLBY DIGITAL A-DSX
DOLBY DIGITAL + PLgx Movie A-DSX
DOLBY DIGITAL + PLgx Music A-DSX
DOLBY DIGITAL + NEO:X Cinema
DOLBY DIGITAL + NEO:X Music
DOLBY DIGITAL + NEO:X Game
DOLBY TrueHD
DOLBY TrueHD + EX
DOLBY TrueHD + PLgx Movie
DOLBY TrueHD + PLgx Music
DOLBY TrueHD + PLgz
DOLBY TrueHD A-DSX
DOLBY TrueHD + PLgx Movie A-DSX
DOLBY TrueHD + PLgx Music A-DSX
DOLBY TrueHD + NEO:X Cinema
DOLBY TrueHD + NEO:X Music
DOLBY TrueHD + NEO:X Game
Appendix
Tips
MOVIE
S
S
S
S
z5
z5
z5
S
S
S
Sound mode
MUSIC
GAME
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
z5
z5
z5
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
z4 Some sound modes cannot be selected, depending on the audio format or number of channels of the input signal. For details, see “Types of input signals, and
corresponding sound modes” (vpage 254).
z5 These modes add new channels to 5.1-channel surround using Audyssey DSX® processing (vpage 170 “Audyssey DSX®”).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
127
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Input signal
Playback
Settings
Sound mode
Appendix
Tips
Note
DOLBY DIGITAL Plus
MOVIE
Sound mode
MUSIC
GAME
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Multi-channel z4
DOLBY DIGITAL Plus + EX
S
DOLBY DIGITAL Plus + PLgx Movie
S
DOLBY DIGITAL Plus + PLgx Music
DOLBY DIGITAL Plus + PLgz
S
Dolby Digital Plus
DOLBY DIGITAL Plus A-DSX
z5
S
DOLBY DIGITAL Plus + PLgx Movie A-DSX
z5
S
DOLBY DIGITAL Plus + PLgx Music A-DSX
z5
DOLBY DIGITAL Plus + NEO:X Cinema
S
DOLBY DIGITAL Plus + NEO:X Music
DOLBY DIGITAL Plus + NEO:X Game
DTS SURROUND
S
DTS ES DSCRT 6.1
S
DTS ES MTRX 6.1
S
DTS 96/24
S
DTS + PLgx Movie
S
DTS
DTS + PLgx Music
DTS + PLgz
S
DTS SURROUND A-DSX
z5
S
DTS + NEO:X Cinema
S
DTS + NEO:X Music
DTS + NEO:X Game
z4 Some sound modes cannot be selected, depending on the audio format or number of channels of the input signal. For details, see
corresponding sound modes” (vpage 254).
z5 These modes add new channels to 5.1-channel surround using Audyssey DSX® processing (vpage 170 “Audyssey DSX®”).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
128
Remote
Index
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
“Types of input signals, and
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
MOVIE
Sound mode
MUSIC
GAME
DTS-HD HI RES
S
S
S
DTS-HD MSTR
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Input signal
Sound mode
Note
DTS-HD MSTR A-DSX
z5
DTS Express
DTS Express A-DSX
DTS-HD /
DTS Express
z5
DTS-HD + PLgx Movie
S
DTS-HD + PLgx Music
S
DTS-HD + PLgz
DTS-HD HI RES A-DSX
z5
DTS-HD + NEO:X Cinema
Multi-channel z4
Appendix
Tips
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
DTS-HD + NEO:X Music
S
DTS-HD + NEO:X Game
S
MULTI CH IN
S
S
S
MULTI CH IN 7.1
S
S
S
MULTI IN + PLgx Movie
S
MULTI IN + PLgx Music
S
MULTI IN + PLgz
S
MULTI CH IN A-DSX
z5
S
PCM multi-channel
MULTI CH IN + PLgx Movie A-DSX
z5
S
MULTI CH IN + PLgx Music A-DSX
z5
MULTI IN + DOLBY EX
z3
S
MULTI IN + NEO:X Cinema
z3
S
MULTI IN + NEO:X Music
z3
MULTI IN + NEO:X Game
z3
z3 This mode cannot be selected when DSD signals from Super Audio CD are input.
z4 Some sound modes cannot be selected, depending on the audio format or number of channels of the input signal. For details, see
corresponding sound modes” (vpage 254).
z5 These modes add new channels to 5.1-channel surround using Audyssey DSX® processing (vpage 170 “Audyssey DSX®”).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
129
Remote
Index
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
“Types of input signals, and
Contents
Connections
Settings
Appendix
Tips
MOVIE
Sound mode
MUSIC
GAME
MULTI CH STEREO
S
S
S
VIRTUAL
S
S
S
Input signal
Multi-channel z4
Playback
Sound mode
Note
z4 Some sound modes cannot be selected, depending on the audio format or number of channels of the input signal. For details, see “Types of input signals, and
corresponding sound modes” (vpage 254).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
130
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
22Views on the display
Blu-ray
DOLBY D + PL z
q
w
qShows a decoder to be used.
•A DOLBY DIGITAL Plus decoder is displayed as “DOLBY D+”.
wShows a decoder that creates sound output.
•“+ PLgz” indicates that the PLgz decoder is being used, and that
front height channel sound is being created.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
131
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
HDMI control function
A recent addition to the HDMI standard is CEC (Consumer Electronics Control), which allows control signals from one device to communicate with
another device via the HDMI cable connection. Not all HDMI-equipped devices have this capability.
Setting procedure
1
Set the HDMI output connector corresponding with the
HDMI control function.
5
Switch the input source of this unit to check that video
from the player connected by HDMI is played back
correctly.
2
Turn the power on for all the devices connected by
HDMI cable.
6
When you turn the TV’s power to standby, check that
the power of this unit also goes to standby.
3
Set the HDMI control function for all devices connected
by HDMI cable.
Set “HDMI Control” (vpage 174) to “On”.
NOTE
•Some functions may not operate depending on the connected TV or player. Check
the owner’s manual of each device for details beforehand.
•The HDMI ZONE2 function is not compatible with the HDMI control function.
•When the HDMI ZONE2 function is used with “HDMI Control” in the menu set to
“On”, the HDMI ZONE2 function may not fully work.
•Please consult the operating instructions for the connected
devices to check the settings.
•Carry out steps 2 and 3 should any of the devices be unplugged.
4
Switch the television input to the HDMI input connected
to this unit.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
132
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
InstaPrevue function
You can display sub screens on the main screen to preview playback video
of the HDMI input connected to this unit. You can also display various
video inputs in a single screen to switch input sources such as Blu-ray,
DVD, and GAME while viewing them on sub screens.
ZONE SELECT
%
•The InstaPrevue function is compatible with the HDMI 1 – 6 connectors. It is not
supported for the HDMI 7 (AUX 1) connector on the front panel.
InstaPrevue
OPTION
uio p
ENTER
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
133
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Switching input sources
Tips
Appendix
Changing the display location of sub
screens
Switch to the desired input source while watching the sub screen.
1
2
Press ZONE SELECT to switch “MAIN”.
You can change the display location of sub screens to a desired location.
Press InstaPrevue.
1
While sub screens are displayed, press OPTION.
3
Use uio p to select the desired input source from the
sub screen, and press ENTER.
2
Press i to select “Location” and use o p to select the
location where you want to display sub screens.
3
Press OPTION to enter the setting.
The main screen (current input video) and sub screens (other input
video) are displayed.
%
Setting how to display sub screens
•The InstaPrevue function is available when HDMI signals are input to the main
screen. However, it is not available while computer’s resolution (e.g. VGA), 3D or
4K video content is being played back.
•The InstaPrevue function is not available when the power of ZONE2 is on.
You can select to display five sub screens or only one sub screen.
1
While sub screens are displayed, press OPTION.
2
Press o p in “HDMI Input” to select how to display sub
screens.
The InstaPrevue setting screen is displayed.
The InstaPrevue setting screen is displayed.
All (Default) : Displays five sub screens.
One at time : Displays only one sub screen.
3
Press OPTION to enter the setting.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
134
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Sleep timer function
You can have the power automatically switched to standby once a set
time has elapsed. This is convenient for viewing and listening while going
to sleep.
The sleep timer function can be set for each zone.
ZONE SELECT
Using the sleep timer
SLEEP
1
Press ZONE SELECT to switch “MAIN”, “ZONE2” or
“ZONE3”.
2
Press SLEEP and display the time you want to set.
•The
indicator on the display lights.
•You can set the sleep timer in the range from 10 to 120 minutes
in steps of 10 minutes.
22To cancel the sleep timer
Press SLEEP to set “Off”.
The
indicator on the display turns off.
%
•The sleep timer is also cancelled when this unit is set to the standby mode or the
MAIN ZONE, ZONE2 or ZONE3 power is turned off.
NOTE
•The sleep timer function cannot turn off the power of devices connected to this
unit. To turn off the power of those connected devices, set up sleep timers on the
connected devices themselves.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
135
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Rec out function
When using the audio/video recording connectors (MEDIA PLAYER
outputs), you can record the audio or video.
This unit
Recorder
Input source select
buttons
VIDEO OUT
MEDIA
PLAYER
MONITOR
ZONE2
AUDIO OUT
MEDIA
PLAYER
L
R
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
136
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Recording on an External Device
1
Press the input source select button to choose the input
source to be recorded.
2
Start recording.
•For operating instructions, refer to the respective device’s
operating instructions.
%
•Recordings you make are for your personal enjoyment and should not be used for
other purposes without permission of the copyright holder.
•To record video signals through this unit, use the video cable for connection
between this unit and the player.
•Make an analog connection for audio signals.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
137
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
Web control function
You can control this unit from a web control screen on a web browser.
Controlling the unit from a web control
PC
Router
This unit
1
Switch the “IP Control” (vpage 199) setting to
“Always On”.
2
Check the IP address of this unit with “Information”
(vpage 199).
Network/Information
%
Marantz SR7008
On
192.168.0.2
000678-000000
Friendly name
DHCP
IP Address
MAC Address
•This unit and the PC need to be connected to the network properly (vpage 53
“Connecting to a home network (LAN)”) in order to use the web control function.
•Depending on the settings of your security-related software, you may not be able
to access this unit from your PC. If this is the case, then change the settings of the
security-related software.
Checking the IP address.
Displays the current network settings of the AVR
3
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
138
Start up the web browser.
Remote
Index
Contents
4
Connections
Playback
Settings
Enter the IP address of this unit in browser’s address
box.
%
5
http://192.168.0.2
Edit View
Favorites Tools Help
INDEX
When thehttp://192.168.0.2
top menu is displayed, click on the menu item
Edit View Favorites Tools Help
youFile
want
to operate.Marantz SR7008
INDEX
Web
Controller
MAIN ZONE
Web Controller
Marantz SR7008
0.0
CBL/SAT
MAIN ZONE
CBL/SAT
0.0 ZONE2
20
NETWORK
ZONE2
NETWORK
20
ZONE3
Setup Menu
CBL/SAT
ZONE3
Setup Menu
CBL/SAT
Setup Menu
Setup Menu
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
•You can use the Web control function with Internet Explorer 8 or later to memorize
and call up various settings on this unit.
To memorize settings, click “SAVE” on the Setup Menu screen.
To call up settings, click “LOAD” on the Setup Menu screen.
For example, if the IP address of this unit is “192.168.0.2”, enter
“http://192.168.0.2”.
File
Tips
139
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Dual backup memory function
The unit stores settings information in nonvolatile memory even when the
main power supply is turned off. Using the Dual Backup Memory function,
you can write settings information to another memory area to back up
saved settings for recovery anytime as needed. Remembering set details
(Backup).
ZONE
SELECT
Remembering set details (Backup)
1
Set the unit in the state you want remembering, and
press and hold DISPLAY and ZONE SELECT for at least
3 seconds.
“MEMORY SAVING” is shown in the display, and the setting details
are remembered.
BACK
%
•The volume is not remembered.
•If remembered details are overwritten, the previously remembered contents are
deleted.
Recalling remembered details
(Recovery)
1
DISPLAY
Press and hold BACK and ZONE SELECT together for at
least 3 seconds.
“MEMORY LOAD” is shown in the display, and the remembered
details are recalled.
%
•If there is no remembered data, “NO BACKUP” is shown in the display, and no
remembered details are recalled.
•As the volume cannot be recalled, it returns to the factory setting volume.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
140
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Panel lock function
To prevent accidental operation of this unit, you can disable operation of
the buttons on the front panel.
Disabling all key button operations
ui ENTER
X
Display
Press X while you press and hold BACK and ENTER with
the unit in standby mode.
2
3
Press ui to select “FP/VOL LOCK On”.
Press ENTER to enter the setting.
All button operations except X are disabled.
Disabling all button operations except
VOLUME
BACK
Front panel
1
Rear panel
141
1
Press X while you press and hold BACK and ENTER with
the unit in standby mode.
2
3
Press ui to select “FP LOCK On”.
Press ENTER to enter the setting.
All button operations except X and VOLUME are disabled.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Canceling the Panel lock function
1
Press X while you press and hold BACK and ENTER with
the unit in standby mode.
2
Press ui to select “FP LOCK zOff”.
3
Press ENTER to enter the setting.
(z The currently set mode.)
The Panel lock function is canceled.
%
•Even when the Panel lock function is set, you can operate the unit using the
remote control unit.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
142
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Remote lock function
When connecting an IR receiver, enable the Remote lock function. When
the function is enabled, you can not perform operations with the remote
control unit.
By default, this function is disabled.
Disabling the sensor function of the
remote control unit
ui ENTER
X
1
When the main unit is in standby mode, press X while
holding down BACK and ENTER on the main unit.
2
3
Press ui to select “RC LOCK On”.
Press ENTER to enter the setting.
The infrared light receiving function is disabled.
Enabling the remote sensor function
BACK
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
143
1
When the main unit is in standby mode, press X while
holding down BACK and ENTER on the main unit.
2
Press ui to select “RC LOCK zOff”.
3
Press ENTER to enter the setting.
(z The currently set mode.)
The infrared light receiving function on the main unit is enabled.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Switches light illumination on/off
You can switch the light illumination around the main display on or off.
The factory setting is “On”.
Light illumination
1
Press and hold DISPLAY on the main unit for 3 seconds.
•Carry out the same procedure if you want to change the settings
again.
DISPLAY
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
144
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
Playback in ZONE2/ZONE3 (Separate room)
You can operate this unit to enjoy video and audio in a room (ZONE2 and ZONE3) that is different from the room where this unit is placed (MAIN ZONE).
You can simultaneously play back the same source in both the MAIN ZONE, ZONE2 and ZONE3. You can also play back separate sources in the MAIN
ZONE, ZONE2 and ZONE3.
Connecting ZONE
22Connection 1 : Connection through the HDMI
ZONE2 connector
You can use the following three methods to play back video and audio in
ZONE2 and ZONE3.
•Connection through the HDMI ZONE2 connector (vpage 145)
•Connection through the video output connector and speaker output
connector (vpage 146)
•Connection through the video output connector and external power
amplifiers (vpage 148)
When a TV is connected to the HDMI ZONE2 OUT connector, you can
play back a video or audio from the device connected to the HDMI 1 – 6
IN connector in ZONE2 (HDMI ZONE2 function).
MAIN ZONE
This unit
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
145
Remote
ZONE2
HDMI
ZONE2
HDMI
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22Connection 2 : Connection through the video output connector and speaker output connector
•When “Assign Mode” (vpage 192) in the menu is set to any of the following audio is output from speakers in ZONE2 or ZONE3.
nn Assign Mode : 7.1ch + ZONE2 or 5.1ch(Bi-Amp) + ZONE2
MAIN ZONE
ZONE2
This unit
VIDEO
VIDEO
IN
(ASSIGNABLE)
VIDEO OUT
3 Blu-ray
MEDIA
PLAYER
Y
PB/
CB
PR/
CR
COMPONENT VIDEO
IN
Y
P B PR
MONITOR/ZONE2
MONITOR
ZONE2
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
or
(L)
w
ASSIGNABLE
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
146
(R)
q
w
Remote
q
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
nn Assign Mode : 5.1ch + ZONE2/3
MAIN ZONE
ZONE2
ZONE3
This unit
VIDEO
MEDIA
PLAYER
VIDEO
IN
(ASSIGNABLE)
VIDEO OUT
3 Blu-ray
Y
PB/
CB
PR/
CR
COMPONENT VIDEO
IN
Y
P B PR
(L)
MONITOR/ZONE2
MONITOR
ZONE2
w
or
(L)
ASSIGNABLE
ASSIGNABLE
Front panel
w
(R)
q
w
q
ASSIGNABLE
IMPEDANCE : 6~8Ω
Display
(R)
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
CLASS 2 WIRING
Rear panel
147
Remote
Index
q
w
q
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
22Connection 3 : Connection through the video output connector and external power amplifiers
The audio signals of this unit’s ZONE2 and ZONE3 audio output connectors are played on the ZONE2 and ZONE3 power amplifiers.
MAIN ZONE
ZONE2
ZONE3
VIDEO
VIDEO
IN
COMPONENT VIDEO
IN
Y
P B PR
Power
amplifier
VIDEO OUT
MEDIA
PLAYER
MONITOR
(ASSIGNABLE)
This unit
AUX IN
or
ZONE2
3 Blu-ray
PB/
CB
Y
PR/
CR
MONITOR/ZONE2
COMPONENT VIDEO OUT
Power
amplifier
AUX IN
ZONE2
ZONE3
FRONT
L
L
R
R
%
•We recommend using high quality pin-plug (RCA type) cables for audio connections in order to prevent noise.
•If you select a same input source for MAIN ZONE and ZONE2, audio playback may be restricted.
•When “Component Video Out” (vpage 177) in the menu is set to “ZONE2”, the component video output connector outputs the ZONE2 video.
•The menu screen is not output in ZONE2.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
148
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Playback in ZONE
ZONE SELECT
Front panel
Press ZONE SELECT to switch “ZONE2” or “ZONE3”.
3
Press the input source select button to select the input
source to be played.
Display
Rear panel
Press POWER X to turn on the ZONE2 or ZONE3 power.
•Also press input source select button when in standby mode, the
power turns on.
•When POWER X is pressed, ZONE2 or ZONE3 turns off.
•Power in ZONE2 or ZONE3 can be turned on or off by pressing
ZONE2 ON/OFF or ZONE3 ON/OFF on the main unit.
The audio signal of the selected source is output to ZONE2 or
ZONE3.
•To perform an operation with the main unit.
Press ZONE SELECT to select the zone to operate and then turn
INPUT SELECTOR to select an input source.
VOLUME df
MUTE
Appendix
1
2
POWER X
Input source
select buttons
Tips
149
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
22Adjusting the volume
Use VOLUME df to adjust the volume.
•At time of purchase, “Volume Limit” (vpage 204) is set to “70
(–10dB)”.
%
•To perform an operation with the main unit, press ZONE SELECT to select the
zone to operate and then turn VOLUME to adjust the volume.
22Turning off the sound temporarily
Press MUTE
.
The sound is reduced to the level set at “Mute Level” (vpage 205)
in the menu.
again.
•To cancel, either adjust the volume or press MUTE
•You can also adjust the volume level to cancel the muting.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
150
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Settings
Menu map
For menu operation, connect a TV to this unit and display the menu on the TV screen. For menu operations, see the following page.
By default, this unit has recommended settings defined. You can customize this unit based on your existing system and your preferences.
22Audio
Setting items
Description
Page
Dialog Level
This setting adjusts the output level to clarify the dialogue output from the center channel.
161
Subwoofer Level
This setting adjusts the volume level for the subwoofer.
161
Subwoofer
Turn subwoofer output on and off.
161
Subwoofer 1 Level
This setting adjusts the volume level for the subwoofer 1.
161
Subwoofer 2 Level
This setting adjusts the volume level for the subwoofer 2.
161
Adjusts surround sound parameters.
162
Home Theater EQ
Gently softens the upper treble range of movie soundtracks to reduce possible harshness and improve clarity.
162
Loudness Management
This sets whether to output as specified in “Dynamic Compression” or output directly without compressing the dynamic
range of audio recorded in the disc.
162
Dynamic Compression
Compress dynamic range (difference between loud and soft sounds).
162
Low Frequency Effects
Adjust the low frequency effects level (LFE).
163
Center Gain
Distributes the dialogue output from the center channel to the front left and right channels and widens the sound image in
the front.
163
Panorama
Assign front L/R signals to also go to the surround channels for wider sound.
163
Dimension
Shift sound image center to front or rear to adjust playback balance.
163
Center Width
Distributes the dialogue output from the center channel to left and right channels and widens the sound image in the front.
164
Height Gain
Control the front height channel volume.
164
Speaker Select
Makes setting for the speakers outputting sound.
164
Surround Parameter
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
151
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Setting items
Tone
Tips
Appendix
Description
Page
Adjusts the tonal quality of the sound.
165
Tone Control
Set the tone control function to on/off.
165
Bass
Adjust bass.
165
Treble
Adjust treble.
165
M-DAX
Expands the low and high frequency components of compressed audio content such as MP3 files to enable richer audio
playback.
165
Audio Delay
Compensates for incorrect timing between video and audio.
166
Volume
Set the MAIN ZONE (room where the unit is located) volume setting.
166
Scale
Set how volume is displayed.
166
Limit
Make a setting for maximum volume.
167
Power On Level
Define the volume setting that is active when the power is turned on.
167
Mute Level
Set the amount of attenuation when muting is on.
167
Makes Audyssey MultEQ® XT32, Audyssey Dynamic EQ®, Audyssey Dynamic Volume®, Audyssey LFC™ and Audyssey DSX®
settings.
167
MultEQ® XT32 compensates for both time and frequency characteristics of the listening area based on Audyssey® Setup
measurement results.
167
Dynamic EQ
Solves the problem of deteriorating sound quality as volume is decreased by taking into account human perception and room
acoustics. Works with MultEQ® XT32.
168
Reference Level Offset
Audyssey Dynamic EQ® is referenced to the standard film mix level.
168
Dynamic Volume
Solves the problem of large variations in volume level between TV, movies and other content (between quiet passages and
loud passages, etc.) by automatically adjusting to the user’s preferred volume setting.
169
Audyssey LFC™
Adjusts the low frequency band to prevent bass and vibration from being conveyed to neighboring rooms.
169
Containment Amount
Audyssey DSX®
Adjusts the amount of low frequency containment. Use higher settings if you have close neighbors.
169
Provides more immersive surround sound by adding the new channels.
170
Stage Width
Adjust sound stage width when using front wide speakers.
170
Stage Height
Adjust sound stage height when using front height speakers.
170
Audyssey
MultEQ® XT32
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
152
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Setting items
Graphic EQ
Tips
Description
Appendix
Page
Uses the graphic equalizer to adjust the tone of each speaker.
171
Speaker Selection
Select whether to adjust tones for individual speakers or for all speakers.
171
Adjust EQ
Adjust tonal balance for each frequency band. Adjust the speaker selected in “Speaker Selection”.
171
Curve Copy
Copy “Audyssey Flat”curve from MultEQ® XT32.
171
22Video
Setting items
Picture Adjust
Description
Page
Adjusts the video quality.
172
Picture Mode
Select the desired picture mode according to the video content and your viewing environment.
172
Contrast
Adjust picture contrast.
172
Brightness
Adjust picture brightness.
172
Saturation
Adjust picture chroma level (color saturation).
172
Hue
Adjust green and red balance. Also called Tint.
172
Noise Reduction
Reduce overall video noise.
173
Enhancer
Emphasize picture sharpness.
173
Makes settings for HDMI video/audio output.
173
Auto Lip Sync
Make automatic compensation for timing shift in audio and video output.
173
HDMI Audio Out
Select HDMI audio output device.
174
Video Output
Selects which HDMI outputs to use.
174
HDMI Pass Through
Selects how the AV receiver will pass HDMI signals to the HDMI output in standby power mode.
174
HDMI Control
You can link operations with devices connected to HDMI and compatible with HDMI Control.
174
Pass Through Source
The AV receiver will “pass through” the sources HDMI signal when in standby.
175
Power Off Control
Links the power standby of this unit to external devices.
175
HDMI Setup
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
153
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Setting items
Output Settings
Tips
Description
Appendix
Page
Makes settings for video output.
175
Video Mode
Make settings for video processing.
175
Video Conversion
The input video signal is converted automatically in conjunction with the connected TV.
175
i/p Scaler
Sets the video input signal for which i/p Scaler processing is performed.
176
Resolution
Set the output resolution.
176
Progressive Mode
Set an appropriate progressive conversion mode for the source video signal.
177
Aspect Ratio
Set the aspect ratio for the video signals output to the HDMI.
177
Component Video Out
Sets whether to use the component video output connector for MAIN ZONE or ZONE2.
177
On Screen Display
Select the on-screen display user interface preferences.
178
Volume
Sets where to display the master volume level.
178
Info
Displays status of operation temporarily when the sound mode is changed, or input source is switched.
178
Now Playing
Sets how long each menu is displayed when the input source is “NETWORK”, “iPod/USB”, or “HD Radio”.
178
Set the video output signal format for the TV you are using.
178
TV Format
22Inputs
Setting items
Description
Page
Input Assign
Changes input connector assignment.
179
Source Rename
Changes the display name for input source.
181
Hide Sources
Remove from the display input sources that are not used.
181
Source Level
Adjusts the playback level of the audio input.
181
Input Select
Sets the audio input mode and decode mode.
182
Input Mode
Set the audio input modes for input sources.
182
Decode Mode
Set the audio decode mode for input source.
182
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
154
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22Speakers
Setting items
Audyssey® Setup
Manual Setup
Description
Page
The acoustic characteristics of the connected speakers and listening room are measured and the optimum settings are made
automatically.
183
Perform when setting the speakers manually or when changing settings made in Audyssey® Setup.
192
Amp Assign
Select power amplifier usage method.
192
Speaker Config.
Indicate speaker presence and select speaker size categories based on bass reproduction capability.
193
Distances
Set distance from listening position to speakers.
195
Levels
Set the volume of the test tone to be the same when it is output from each speaker.
196
Crossovers
Set the maximum frequency of the bass signal output from each channel to the subwoofer.
197
Bass
Set subwoofer and LFE signal range playback.
198
Impedance
Set the impedance of connected speakers.
198
Front Speaker
Set the front speaker A/B to use for every sound mode.
198
22Network
Setting items
Description
Page
Information
Display network information.
199
IP Control
Enables network communication in standby power mode.
199
Friendly Name
The Friendly Name is the name of this unit displayed on the network. You can change the Friendly Name according to your
preferences.
199
Settings
Make settings for wired LAN.
200
Diagnostics
Used to check the network connection.
201
Maintenance Mode
Use when receiving maintenance from a Marantz service engineer or custom installer.
202
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
155
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22General
Setting items
Description
Page
Language
Sets the language for display the menu on the TV screen.
203
ZONE2 Setup / ZONE3 Setup
Makes settings for audio playback with multi-zone (ZONE2, ZONE3).
203
Bass
Adjust bass.
203
Treble
Adjust treble.
203
High Pass Filter
Make settings for cutting the low range to reduce distortion in the bass.
203
Lch Level
Adjust the left channel output level.
204
Rch Level
Adjust the right channel output level.
204
Channel
Sets stereo/monaural.
204
HDMI Audio (ZONE2 only)
Selects the audio signal format for playing an HDMI source in ZONE2.
204
Volume Level
Set the volume output level.
204
Volume Limit
Make a setting for maximum volume.
204
Power On Volume
Define the volume setting that is active when the power is turned on.
204
Mute Level
Set the amount of attenuation when muting is on.
205
Zone Rename
Change the display title of each zone to one you prefer.
205
Trigger Out 1 / Trigger Out 2
Selects when to activate trigger out.
205
Auto Standby
Sets the time for switching to auto standby when there are no audio or video signals input into this unit.
206
Front Display
Makes settings related to the display on this unit.
206
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
156
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Setting items
Information
Tips
Appendix
Description
Page
Show information about receiver settings, input signals, etc.
207
Audio
Shows information about audio input signals.
207
Video
Shows information about video input signal and HDMI Monitor.
207
ZONE
Shows information about each zone.
207
Firmware
Displays system information.
207
Notifications
Displays and sets notifications from Marantz.
208
Usage Data
Selects whether or not to send anonymous usage data to Marantz.
208
Firmware
Checks for the latest firmware information about updates and upgrades, updates the firmware, and sets up the notification
message display.
209
Update
Update the firmware of the receiver.
209
Notifications
Sets whether or not to display a notification message when new firmware is released.
209
Add New Feature
Display new features that can be downloaded to this unit and perform an upgrade.
210
Protect settings from inadvertent changes.
211
Setup Lock
22Setup Assistant
Setting items
Description
Page
Begin Setup
Perform basic installation/connections/settings from the beginning according to the guidance indicated on the TV screen.
Language Select
Perform settings item by item according to the guidance indicated on the TV screen.
Speaker Setup
Speaker Calibration
Network Setup
Input Setup
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
157
Remote
Index
C7
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Menu operation
ZONE SELECT
uio p
ENTER
SETUP
BACK
1
2
Press ZONE SELECT to switch “MAIN”.
3
Use ui p to select the menu to be set or operated,
then press ENTER.
4
5
Use o p to change to desired setting.
Press SETUP.
The menu is displayed on the TV screen.
Press ENTER to enter the setting.
•To return to the previous item, press BACK.
•Exiting the Menu, press SETUP while the menu is displayed.
The menu display disappears.
0–9
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
158
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Inputting characters
•On this unit, you can change the name displayed on the following screens to the names that you prefer.
•Preset Name (vpage 76)
•Text Search (vpage 113)
•Source Rename (vpage 181)
•Friendly Name (vpage 199)
•Zone Rename (vpage 205)
•Character input for the network functions (vpage 80, 87, 91, 98, 101, 200)
•The following two methods can be used for inputting characters.
•Using the keyboard screen (vpage 160)
•Using the number buttons (vpage 160)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
159
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Using the keyboard screen
1
Using the number buttons
Display the screen for inputting characters.
GExampleH Source Rename screen
Inputs/Source Rename
CBL/SAT
Insert
I
J
K
L M
!
“
S
T U V W X Y
(
)
* +
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
a/A
When the keyboard screen is displayed, press 0 – 9.
2
Place the cursor at the character to be changed with o
p and press the number button (0 – 9) until the desired
character is displayed.
‘
Space
,
;
Cancel
Z
#
< = >
OK
Change the display name for this source
2
Select a character to be changed.
qUse uio p to select “,” or “.”.
wPress ENTER to place the cursor at the character to
be changed.
3
Each time ENTER is pressed, the cursor moves by one character.
3
Select a character to be input with uio p then press
ENTER.
4
5
Repeat steps 2 and 3 to change the name.
The 10 key input screen is displayed.
•The types of characters that can be input are as shown below.
Delete
F G H
N O P Q R
$ % &
1
CBL/SAT
Clear
A B C D E
1.@-_/:˜
MNOmno6
ABCabc2
PQRSpqrs7
DEFdef3
TUVtuv8
GHIghi4
WXYZwxyz9
JKLjkl5
0 (Space) ! “ # $ % & ‘ ( ) z + ,
;<=>?[\]^`{|}
Repeat step 2 to change the name then press ENTER to
register it.
Use uio p to select “OK”, then press ENTER.
Front panel
Display
Appendix
Tips
Rear panel
160
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Audio
Make audio-related settings.
Dialog Level
Subwoofer Level
This setting adjusts the output level to clarify the dialogue output from the
center channel.
This setting adjusts the volume level for the subwoofer.
22Subwoofer
22Level
Turn subwoofer output on and off.
On (Default) : The subwoofer is used.
Off : The subwoofer is not used.
–12.0dB – +12.0dB (Default : 0.0dB)
%
•This can be set when the sound mode is “DIRECT” and the “Subwoofer
Mode” (vpage 198) is “LFE+Main”.
22Subwoofer 1 Level
This setting adjusts the volume level for the subwoofer 1.
–12.0dB – +12.0dB (Default : 0.0dB)
22Subwoofer 2 Level
This setting adjusts the volume level for the subwoofer 2.
–12.0dB – +12.0dB (Default : 0.0dB)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
161
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22Loudness Management
Surround Parameter
This sets whether to output as specified in “Dynamic Compression”
or output directly without compressing the dynamic range of audio
recorded in the disc.
On (Default) : Outputs using the settings made in “Dynamic
Compression” and “Dialogue normalization function”
(vpage 207) are enabled.
Off : “Dynamic Compression” settings and “Dialogue Normalization”
are disabled, and the signals on the disc are output as is.
You can adjust the surround audio sound field effects to match your
preferences.
The items (parameters) that can be adjusted depend on the signal
being input and the currently set sound mode. For details on the
adjustable parameters, see “Sound modes and surround parameters”
(vpage 251).
%
•Some setting items cannot be set while playback is stopped. Make the settings
during playback.
%
•This can be set in the Dolby TrueHD mode.
22Home Theater EQ
22Dynamic Compression
Gently softens the upper treble range of movie soundtracks to reduce
possible harshness and improve clarity.
On : “Home Theater EQ” is used.
Off (Default) : “
Home Theater EQ” is not used.
Compress dynamic range (difference between loud and soft sounds).
Auto : Automatic dynamic range compression on/off control according
to source.
Low / Medium / High : These set the compression level.
Off : Dynamic range compression is always off.
%
•You can set “Auto” only for the Dolby TrueHD source.
•The default setting is “Off”. When the input signal is Dolby TrueHD source,
the default setting is “Auto”.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
162
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Low Frequency Effects
Tips
22Panorama
Adjust the low-frequency effects level (LFE).
Assign front L/R signals to also go to the surround channels for wider
sound.
On : Set.
Off (Default) : Do not set.
nn When “Input Mode” is set other than to “7.1CH IN”
–10dB – 0dB (Default)
nn When “Input Mode” is set to “7.1CH IN”
0dB / +5dB / +10dB (Default) / +15dB
%
•You can set this when the sound mode is Dolby PLg/gx in the “Music” mode.
22Dimension
%
•For proper playback of the different sources, we recommend setting to the
values below.
•Dolby Digital sources : 0dB
•DTS movie sources : 0dB
•DTS music sources : –10dB
Shift sound image center to front or rear to adjust playback balance.
0 – 6 (Default : 3)
%
•You can set this when the sound mode is Dolby PLg/gx in the “Music” mode.
•As you set a smaller number, the surround sound field shifts backward; as you
set a larger number, the surround sound field shifts forward.
22Center Gain
Distributes the dialogue output from the center channel to the front left
and right channels and widens the sound image in the front.
0.0 – 1.0
%
•You can set this when the sound mode is set to DTS NEO:X.
•The smaller the value, the more dialogue is concentrated on the center
channel. The larger the value, the more dialogue is distributed to front left and
right channels, and the more the sound image widens in the front.
Front panel
Display
Appendix
Rear panel
163
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Center Width
Tips
Appendix
22Speaker Select
Distributes the dialogue output from the center channel to left and right
channels and widens the sound image in the front.
0 – 7 (Default : 3)
Makes settings for the speakers outputting sound.
Surround Back : Sound is output from the surround back speakers.
Height : Sound is output from the front height speakers.
Wide : Sound is output from the front wide speakers.
Back/Height : Sound is output from the surround back and front height
speakers.
Back/Wide : Sound is output from the surround back and front wide
speakers.
Height/Wide : Sound is output from the front height and front wide
speakers.
%
•You can set this when the sound mode is Dolby PLg/gx in the “Music” mode.
•The smaller the value, the more dialogue is concentrated on the center
channel. The larger the value, the more dialogue is distributed to front left and
right channels, and the more the sound image widens in the front.
22Height Gain
Control the front height channel volume.
Low : R
educe the front height channel volume.
Normal (Default) : Front height channel sound is output with standard
sound volume.
High : Increase the front height channel volume.
%
•This can be set when “Assign Mode” (vpage 192) is set to “9.1ch(SB/FH/
FW)”, “7.1ch + ZONE2”, “7.1ch(Bi-Amp)” or “7.1ch + Front B”.
•The speakers that can be selected by the “Main Speakers” (vpage 193)
setting are changed.
•You can set this when the sound mode is “MULTI CH STEREO” or “NEO:X”.
%
22Set Defaults
•You can set this in the “PLgz” sound mode or when using the PLgz decoder.
The “Surround Parameter” settings are returned to the default settings.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
164
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tone
Appendix
M-DAX
Adjust the tonal quality of the sound.
Compressed audio formats such as MP3, WMA (Windows Media Audio)
and MPEG-4 AAC reduce the amount of data by eliminating signal
components that are hard for the human ear to hear. The “M-DAX”
function generates the signals eliminated upon compression, restoring the
sound to conditions near those of the original sound before compression.
It also restores the original bass characteristics for a rich and expanded
tonal range.
22Tone Control
Set the tone control function to on/off.
On : Allow tone adjustment (bass, treble).
Off (Default) : P
layback without tone adjustment.
22Bass
22Mode
Adjust bass.
–6dB – +6dB (Default : 0dB)
High : Optimized mode for compressed sources with very weak highs
(64 kbps and under).
Medium : Apply suitable bass and treble boost for all compressed
sources (96 kbps and under).
Low : Optimized mode for compressed sources with normal highs (96
kbps and over).
Off (Default) : Do not use “M-DAX”.
22Treble
Adjust treble.
–6dB – +6dB (Default : 0dB)
%
%
•This cannot be set when the sound mode is set to “DIRECT” or “PURE
DIRECT”.
Front panel
Tips
Display
Rear panel
•This item can be set with analog signals or PCM signal (Sample Rate =
44.1/48 kHz) is input.
•“M-DAX” settings are stored for each input source.
•This cannot be set when the sound mode is set to “DIRECT” or “PURE
DIRECT”.
•This can be set by pressing M-DAX on the main unit.
•The M-DAX indicator lights.
165
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Audio Delay
Appendix
Volume
While viewing video, manually adjust the time to delay audio output so
that the video and audio are synchronized.
0ms (Default) – 200ms
Set the MAIN ZONE (room where the unit is located) volume setting.
22Scale
Set how volume is displayed.
0 – 98 (Default) : Display in the range 0 (Min) to 98.
–79.5dB – 18.0dB : Display ---dB (Min), in the range –79.5 dB to 18.0
dB.
%
•This item can be set within the range of 0 to 100 ms when “Auto Lip Sync”
(vpage 173) is set to “On” and when a TV compatible with Auto Lip Sync is
connected.
•Store “Audio Delay” for each input source.
•Audio Delay for game mode can be set when “Video Mode” (vpage 175) is set
to “Auto” or “Game”.
Front panel
Tips
Display
Rear panel
%
•The “Scale” setting applies to all zones.
166
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Limit
Tips
Appendix
Audyssey
Make a setting for maximum volume.
60 (–20dB) / 70 (–10dB) / 80 (0dB)
Off (Default)
Set Audyssey MultEQ® XT32, Audyssey Dynamic EQ®, Audyssey Dynamic
Volume®, Audyssey LFC™ and Audyssey DSX®. These can be selected
after Audyssey® Setup has been performed. For additional information on
Audyssey technology, please see page 257.
22Power On Level
%
Define the volume setting that is active when the power is turned on.
Last (Default) : Use the memorized setting from the last session.
Mute : A
lways use the muting on condition when power is turned on.
1 – 98 (–79dB – 18dB) : T
he volume is adjusted to the set level.
•“MultEQ® XT32”, “Dynamic EQ”, “Dynamic Volume” and “Audyssey LFC™”
settings are stored for each input source.
•“MultEQ® XT32”, “Dynamic EQ”, “Dynamic Volume” and “Audyssey LFC™”
cannot be set when the sound mode is set to “DIRECT” or “PURE DIRECT”.
22MultEQ® XT32
22Mute Level
MultEQ® XT32 compensates for both time and frequency characteristics
of the listening area based on Audyssey® Setup measurement results.
Selection is done from three types of compensation curves. We
recommend the “Audyssey” setting.
Audyssey (Default) : Optimize the frequency response of all speakers.
Audyssey Byp. L/R : Optimize frequency response of speakers except
front L and R speakers.
Audyssey Flat : Optimize frequency response of all speakers to flat
response.
Graphic EQ : Apply frequency response set with “Graphic EQ”
(vpage 171).
Off : Turn “MultEQ® XT32” equalizer off.
Set the amount of attenuation when muting is on.
Full (Default) : T
he sound is muted entirely.
–40dB : The sound is attenuated by 40 dB down.
–20dB : The sound is attenuated by 20 dB down.
%
•When using headphones, “MultEQ® XT32” is automatically set to “Off”.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
167
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Dynamic EQ
Tips
Appendix
22Reference Level Offset
Solves the problem of deteriorating sound quality as volume is
decreased by taking into account human perception and room
acoustics. Works with MultEQ® XT32.
On (Default) : Use Dynamic EQ.
Off : D
o not use Dynamic EQ.
Audyssey Dynamic EQ® is referenced to the standard film mix level. It
makes adjustments to maintain the reference response and surround
envelopment when the volume is turned down from 0 dB. However,
film reference level is not always used in music or other non-film
content. Dynamic EQ Reference Level Offset provides three offsets
from the film level reference (5 dB, 10 dB, and 15 dB) that can be
selected when the mix level of the content is not within the standard.
Recommended setting levels for content are shown below.
0dB (Film Ref) (Default) : Optimized for content such as movies.
5dB : Select this setting for content that has a very wide dynamic
range, such as classical music.
10dB : Select this setting for jazz or other music that has a wider
dynamic range. This setting should also be selected for TV
content as that is usually mixed at 10 dB below film reference.
15dB : Select this setting for pop/rock music or other program material
that is mixed at very high listening levels and has a compressed
dynamic range.
%
•When the menu “Dynamic EQ” setting is “On”, it is not possible to do “Tone
Control” (vpage 165) adjustment.
•This can be set by pressing DYNAMIC EQ on the main unit.
%
•Setting is enabled when “Dynamic EQ” (vpage 168) is “On”.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
168
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Dynamic Volume
Tips
About Audyssey LFC™ (Low Frequency Containment)
Audyssey LFC™ solves the problem of low frequency sounds
disturbing people in neighboring rooms or apartments. Audyssey
LFC™ dynamically monitors the audio content and removes the
low frequencies that pass through walls, floors and ceilings. It then
applies psychoacoustic processing to restore the perception of low
bass for listeners in the room. The result is great sound that no longer
disturbs the neighbors.
Solves the problem of large variations in volume level between TV,
movies and other content (between quiet passages and loud passages,
etc.) by automatically adjusting to the user’s preferred volume setting.
Heavy : M
ost adjustment to softest and loudest sounds.
Medium : Medium adjustment to loudest and softest sound.
Light : Least adjustment to loudest and softest sounds.
Off (Default) : D
o not use “Dynamic Volume”.
22Containment Amount
%
Adjusts the amount of low frequency containment. Use higher settings
if you have close neighbors.
1 – 7 (Default : 4)
•If “Dynamic Volume” is set to “Yes” in “Audyssey® Setup” (vpage 183),
the setting is automatically changed to “Medium”.
•This can be set by pressing DYNAMIC VOLUME on the main unit.
22Audyssey LFC™
%
Adjusts the low frequency band to prevent bass and vibration from
being conveyed to neighboring rooms.
On : Use “Audyssey LFC™”.
Off (Default) : Do not use “Audyssey LFC™”.
•Setting is enabled when “Audyssey LFC™” is “On”.
%
•“Audyssey LFC™” cannot be set up if “Audyssey® Setup” is not completed.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
169
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Audyssey DSX®
%
•“Audyssey DSX®” can be set when you are using front height speakers or
front wide speakers.
•“Wides/Heights” can only be set when the “Assign Mode” (vpage 192)
setting is other than “9.1ch(SB/FH/FW)”.
•“Audyssey DSX®” is only valid when using a center speaker.
•“Audyssey DSX®” is valid when sound mode is DOLBY sound mode or DTS
sound mode other than PLgz and DTS NEO:X.
•“Audyssey DSX®” cannot be configured if the HD Audio source being played
includes Front height and Front wide channels. In this case, the respective
channels are played back using the input signals.
•This can be set by pressing A-DSX on the main unit.
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
About Audyssey Dynamic Surround Expansion (A-DSX)
Audyssey DSX® is a scalable system that adds new speakers to
improve surround impression. Starting with a 5.1 system Audyssey
DSX® first adds Wide channels for the biggest impact on envelopment.
Research in human hearing has proven that information from the
Wide channels is much more critical in the presentation of a realistic
soundstage than the Back Surround channels found in traditional 7.1
systems. Audyssey DSX® then creates a pair of Height channels to
reproduce the next most important acoustical and perceptual cues.
In addition to these new Wide and Height channels, Audyssey DSX®
applies Surround Envelopment Processing to enhance the blend
between the front and surround channels.
Provides more immersive surround sound by adding the new channels.
Wides : T
urn on Audyssey DSX® processing for wide expansion.
Heights : Turn on Audyssey DSX® processing for height expansion.
Wides/Heights : Turns on Audyssey DSX® processing for wide and
height expansion.
Off (Default) : D
o not set Audyssey DSX®.
Front panel
Tips
22Stage Width
Adjust sound stage width when using front wide speakers.
–10 – +10 (Default : 0)
22Stage Height
Adjust sound stage height when using front height speakers.
–10 – +10 (Default : 0)
170
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
22Curve Copy
Graphic EQ
Copy “Audyssey Flat” curve from “MultEQ® XT32” (vpage 167).
Use the 9 band graphic equalizer to adjust the tone of each speaker.
%
%
•“Curve Copy” is displayed after Audyssey® Setup has been performed.
•“Graphic EQ” can be set when “MultEQ® XT32” (vpage 167) setting is
“Graphic EQ”.
•Speakers for which “Graphic EQ” can be set differ according to the sound mode.
22Set Defaults
The “Graphic EQ” settings are returned to the default settings.
22Speaker Selection
Select whether to adjust tones for individual speakers or for all
speakers.
All
Left/Right (Default)
Each
22Adjust EQ
Adjust tonal balance for each frequency band. Adjust the speaker
selected in “Speaker Selection”.
q Select the speaker.
w Select the adjustment frequency band.
63Hz / 125Hz / 250Hz / 500Hz / 1kHz / 2kHz / 4kHz / 8kHz / 16kHz
e Adjust the level.
–20.0dB – +6.0dB (Default : 0.0dB)
Front panel
Appendix
Display
Rear panel
171
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Video
Make video-related settings.
Picture Adjust
%
•You can also press OPTION to make these settings from “Picture Mode”
(vpage 116) in the option menu.
•The default settings are as follows.
•For “NETWORK” and “iPod/USB” input sources : Streaming
•For input sources other than “NETWORK” and “iPod/USB” : Off
Picture quality can be adjusted.
%
•Can be set when the “Video Conversion” (vpage 175) setting is “On”.
•Can be set when “HDMI”, “COMP” or “VIDEO” (vpage 180) is assigned for
each input source.
22Contrast
22Picture Mode
Adjust picture contrast.
–6 – +6 (Default : 0)
Select the desired picture mode according to the video content and
your viewing environment.
Standard : The standard mode suited for most living room viewing
environments.
Movie : A mode suited for watching movies in a dark room such as a
theater room.
Vivid : A mode that makes graphic images for games, etc. brighter
and more vivid.
Streaming : A
mode suited for low bit rate video sources.
Custom : Adjusts the picture quality manually.
Off : N
o picture quality adjustment is done with this unit.
22Brightness
Adjust picture brightness.
0 (Default) – +12
22Saturation
Adjust picture chroma level (color saturation).
–6 – +6 (Default : 0)
22Hue
Adjust green and red balance. Also called Tint.
–6 – +6 (Default : 0)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
172
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Noise Reduction
Tips
Appendix
HDMI Setup
Reduce overall video noise.
Low / Medium / High / Off (Default)
Make settings for HDMI video/audio output.
NOTE
22Enhancer
•When “HDMI Pass Through” and “HDMI Control” is set to “On”, it consumes
more standby power. If you are not using this unit for an extended period, it is
recommended that you unplug the power cord from the power outlet.
Emphasize picture sharpness.
0 (Default) – +12
22Auto Lip Sync
%
•“Contrast”, “Brightness”, “Saturation”, “Hue”, “Noise Reduction”
“Enhancer” can be set when “Picture Mode” is set to “Custom”.
•“Picture Adjust” cannot be set when 4K signals are input.
Make automatic compensation for timing shift in audio and video
output.
On (Default) : Compensated.
Off : Not compensated.
and
22HDMI Audio Out
Select HDMI audio output device.
AVR (Default) : Play back through speakers connected to the unit.
TV : Play back through TV connected to the unit.
%
•When the HDMI control function is activated, priority is given to the TV audio
setting (vpage 132 “HDMI control function”).
•When the power of this unit is on and “HDMI Audio Out” is set to “TV”,
audio is output as 2-channel from the HDMI OUT connector.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
173
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Video Output
Tips
Appendix
22HDMI Pass Through
Selects which HDMI outputs to use.
Auto(Dual) (Default) : The presence of a TV connected to the HDMI
MONITOR 1 or HDMI MONITOR 2 connector is
detected automatically, and that TV connection
is used.
Monitor 1 : A TV connected to the HDMI MONITOR 1 connector is
always used.
Monitor 2 : A TV connected to the HDMI MONITOR 2 connector is
always used.
Selects how the AV receiver will pass HDMI signals to the HDMI
output in standby power mode.
On (Default) : Passes the selected HDMI input through the AV
receiver’s HDMI output when the AV receiver is in
standby power mode.
Off : No HDMI signals are passed through the AV receiver’s HDMI
output in standby power mode.
22HDMI Control
You can link operations with devices connected to HDMI and
compatible with HDMI Control.
On : Use HDMI control function.
Off (Default) : Do not use HDMI control function.
%
•If both the HDMI MONITOR 1 and HDMI MONITOR 2 connectors are
connected and “Resolution” (vpage 176) is set to “Auto”, the signals are
output with a resolution compatible with both TV.
•With “Resolution” (vpage 176) not set to “Auto”, check whether the
TV you are using is compatible with the resolution under “Video” – “HDMI
Monitor 1” or “HDMI Monitor 2” (vpage 207).
•This can be set by pressing HDMI OUT on the main unit.
%
•Please consult the operating instructions for each connected device to check
the settings.
•Refer to “HDMI control function” (vpage 132) for more information about
the HDMI control function.
NOTE
•If the “HDMI Control” settings have been changed, always reset the power
to connected devices after the change.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
174
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Pass Through Source
The AV receiver will “pass through” the sources HDMI signal when
in standby.
Last : Choose this option to “pass through” the last used HDMI input
video source.
CBL/SAT (Default) / DVD / Blu-ray / GAME / AUX1 / AUX2 / MEDIA
PLAYER / CDz : Choose this option to “pass through” the selected
input source when in standby.
zz “Pass Through Source” can be set when any of the HDMI connectors is
assigned to “CD” for the input source in the “Input Assign” (vpage 179)
setting.
22Power Off Control
Links the power standby of this unit to external devices.
All (Default) : If power to a connected TV is turned off independently
of the input source, power to this unit is automatically
set to standby.
Video : With an input source being selected that is assigned either
“HDMI”, “COMP” or “VIDEO” (vpage 180), when you
turn the power of the TV off, power to this unit is automatically
set to standby.
Off : T
his unit does not link with power to a TV.
Rear panel
Output Settings
Makes settings for video output.
%
•Can be set when each input source is assigned “HDMI”, “COMP” or “VIDEO”
(vpage 180).
•“Resolution”, “Progressive Mode” and “Aspect Ratio” can be set when “i/p
Scaler” is set to anything other than “Off”.
•“Output Settings” can not be set when 4K signals are input.
Make settings for video processing.
Auto (Default) : Process video automatically based on the HDMI
content information.
Game : Always process video for game content.
Movie : Always process video for movie content.
•“Pass Through Source” can be set when “HDMI Control” is set to “On” or
“HDMI Pass Through” is set to “On”.
Display
Appendix
22Video Mode
%
Front panel
Tips
%
•If “Video Mode” is set to “Auto”, the mode is switched according to the
input contents.
22Video Conversion
The input video signal is converted automatically in conjunction with
the connected TV (vpage 245 “Video conversion function”).
On (Default) : The input video signal is converted.
Off : The input video signal is not converted.
175
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22i/p Scaler
Set the output resolution.
You can set “Resolution” separately for HDMI output of the analog
video input and HDMI input.
Auto (Default) : The number of pixels the TV connected to the HDMI
MONITOR OUT connector supports is detected
automatically and the appropriate output resolution is
set.
480p/576p / 1080i / 720p / 1080p / 1080p:24Hz / 4K :
Set the output resolution.
nn When the input source is set other than to “iPod/USB” and
“NETWORK”
Analog (Default) : Use i/p (interlace-to-progressive) scaler function for
analog video signals.
Analog & HDMI : Use i/p scaler function for analog and HDMI video
signal.
HDMI : Use i/p scaler function for HDMI video signals.
Off : D
o not use i/p scaler function.
%
•When “i/p Scaler” is set to “Analog & HDMI”, the resolution of both the
analog video input signal and HDMI input signal can be set.
•When set to “1080p:24Hz”, you can enjoy film-like pictures for film sources
(in 24 Hz). For video sources and mixed sources, we recommend setting the
resolution to “1080p”.
•It is not possible to convert a 50 Hz signal into 1080p/24Hz. It is output at a
resolution of 1080p/50Hz.
nn When the input source is set to “iPod/USB” and “NETWORK”
On (Default) : Use i/p scaler function.
Off : D
o not use i/p scaler function.
%
•“Analog & HDMI” can be set for input sources for which an HDMI input
connector is assigned.
•Which items can be set depend on the input source assigned to each input
connector.
•This function is not effective when the input signal is “x.v.Color”, 3D,
sYCC 601 color, Adobe RGB color, Adobe YCC 601 color or computer
resolutions.
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
22Resolution
Sets the video input signal for which i/p Scaler processing is performed.
Front panel
Tips
176
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Progressive Mode
Tips
Component Video Out
Set an appropriate progressive conversion mode for the source video
signal.
Auto (Default) : The video signal is automatically detected and the
appropriate mode is set.
Video : Select mode suitable for video playback.
Video and Film : Select mode suitable for video and 30-frame film
material playback.
Set the zone to which the component video output connector is assigned.
MAIN ZONE (Default) : Assigns the component video output connector
to MAIN ZONE.
ZONE2 : Assigns the component video output connector to ZONE2.
%
•This item can be set when “i/p Scaler” is set to anything other than “Off”.
22Aspect Ratio
Set the aspect ratio for the video signals output to the HDMI.
16:9 (Default) : Output at 16:9 aspect ratio.
4:3 : Output at 4:3 aspect ratio with black bars on the sides of a 16:9 TV
screen (except for 480p/576p output).
%
•“Aspect Ratio” can be set when “i/p Scaler” is set to anything other than
“Off”.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
177
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
On Screen Display
Tips
Appendix
TV Format
Select the on-screen display user interface preferences.
Set the video signal format to be output for the TV you are using.
22Volume
22Format
Sets where to display the master volume level.
Bottom (Default) : D
isplay at the bottom.
Top : Display at the top.
Off : T
urn display off.
NTSC (Default) : Select NTSC output.
PAL : Select PAL output.
%
•“Format” can also be set by the following procedure. However, the menu
screen is not displayed.
1.Press and hold the main unit’s STATUS and ZONE SELECT for at least 3
seconds.
“zVideo Format <NTSC>” appears on the display.
2. Use the main unit’s o p and set the video signal format.
3.Press the main unit’s ENTER to complete the setting.
%
•When the master volume display is hard to see when superimposed text
(closed captioning) or movie subtitles are present, set to “Top”.
22Info
Displays status of operation temporarily when the sound mode is
changed, or input source is switched.
On (Default) : Turn display on.
Off : T
urn display off.
NOTE
•When a format other than the video format of the connected TV is set, the
picture will not be displayed properly.
22Now Playing
Sets the display time for the playback display when the input source is
“NETWORK”, “iPod/USB” or “HD Radio”.
Always On (Default) : S
how display continuously.
Auto Off : Show display for 30 seconds after operation.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
178
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
Inputs
Perform settings related to input source playback.
You do not have to change the settings to use the unit. Make settings when needed.
Input Assign
%
•By default, each item is set as follows.
By making connections as indicated by the input sources printed on the
audio/video input connectors of this unit, you can just press one of the
input source select buttons to easily play back audio or video from a
connected device.
If you have made connections that are different to the default settings,
the HDMI input connectors, digital audio input connectors, analog audio
input connectors, component video input connectors and video input
connectors assigned to each input source can be changed using these
items.
Input source
Inputs/Input Assign
Set Defaults
CBL/SAT
DVD
Blu-ray
GAME
MEDIA PLAYER
TV AUDIO
AUX1
AUX2
CD
HDMI
DIGITAL
ANALOG
COMP
VIDEO
1
2
3
4
5
FRONT
6
-
COAX1
COAX2
OPT1
OPT2
1
2
3
4
FRONT
5
1
2
3
-
1
2
3
FRONT
-
Display
Rear panel
DIGITAL
ANALOG
COMP
1
COAX1
1
1
1
DVD
2
COAX2
2
2
2
VIDEO
Blu-ray
3
–
3
3
–
GAME
4
–
–
–
–
MEDIA PLAYER
5
–
4
–
3
TV AUDIO
–
OPT1
–
–
–
AUX1
FRONT
–
FRONT
–
FRONT
AUX2
6
–
–
–
–
CD
–
OPT2
5
–
–
nn TV set top box/satellite users please note
When using the optical or coaxial digital audio output on a TV/satellite
box :
To play the video signal assigned to “HDMI” combined with the audio
signal assigned at “Input Assign” – “DIGITAL”, you will also need to
select “Digital” in the “Input Mode” (vpage 182).
Changes HDMI input assignments
Front panel
HDMI
CBL/SAT
179
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22HDMI
Tips
22COMP (Component video)
Set this to change the HDMI input connectors assigned to the input
sources.
1 / 2 / 3 / 4 / 5 / 6 / FRONT :
Assign an HDMI input connector to the selected input source.
– : Do not assign an HDMI input connector to the selected input source.
Set this to change the component video input connectors assigned to
the input sources.
1 / 2 / 3 : Assign the component video input connector to the selected
input source.
– : Do not assign a component video input connector to the selected
input source.
%
22VIDEO
•When “HDMI Control” (vpage 174) is set to “On”, HDMI input connector
cannot be assigned to “TV AUDIO”.
Set this to change the composite video input connectors assigned to
the input sources.
1 / 2 / 3 / FRONT : Assign the video input connector to the selected
input source.
– : Do not assign a video input connector to the selected input source.
22DIGITAL
Set this to change the digital audio input connectors assigned to the
input sources.
COAX1 (Coaxial) / COAX2 / OPT1 (Optical) / OPT2 :
Assign a digital audio input connector to the selected input source.
– : Do not assign a digital audio input connector to the selected input
source.
22Set Defaults
The “Input Assign” settings are returned to the default settings.
22ANALOG
Set this to change the analog audio input connectors assigned to the
input sources.
1 / 2 / 3 / 4 / 5 / FRONT : Assign a analog audio input connector to the
selected input source.
– : Do not assign a analog audio input connector to the selected input
source.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
180
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Source Rename
Tips
Appendix
Source Level
Change the display name for input source.
This is convenient when the name of your device and the input source
name of this unit are different. You can change the name to suit your
needs. When the renaming is completed, the name is displayed on this
unit’s display and on the menu screen.
CBL/SAT / DVD / Blu-ray / GAME / AUX1 / AUX2 / MEDIA PLAYER / CD /
TV AUDIO / PHONO / M-XPort : Change the display name of the selected
input source.
Set Defaults : The “Source Rename” settings are returned to the default
settings.
•This function corrects the playback level of the selected input source’s
audio input.
•Make this setting if there are differences in the input volume levels
between the different sources.
22Source Level
nn When the input source is set to “iPod/USB”, “NETWORK” and
“HD Radio”
–12dB – +12dB (Default : 0dB)
22Analog Inputs / Digital Inputs
%
•Up to 12 characters can be input. For character input, see page 159.
nn When the input source is set other than to “iPod/USB”,
“NETWORK” and “HD Radio”
–12dB – +12dB (Default : 0dB)
Hide Sources
Remove from the display input sources that are not used.
Show (Default) : Use this source.
Hide : D
o not use this source.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
%
•The analog input level can be adjusted independently for input sources for which
“ANALOG” is assigned at “Input Assign” (vpage 179).
•The digital input level can be adjusted independently for input sources for which
“DIGITAL” is assigned at “Input Assign” (vpage 179).
181
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
22Decode Mode
Input Select
Set the audio decode mode for input source.
Auto (Default) : Detect type of digital input signal and decode and play
automatically.
PCM : Decode and play only PCM input signals.
DTS : Decode and play only DTS input signals.
Set the audio input mode and decode mode of each input source.
The input modes available for selection may vary depending on the input
source.
22Input Mode
Set the audio input modes for input sources.
It is normally recommended to set the audio input mode to “Auto”.
Auto (Default) : Automatically detect input signal and perform playback.
HDMI : Play only signals from HDMI input.
Digital : P
lay only signals from digital input.
Analog : Play only signals from analog input.
7.1CH IN : Only signals input from the 7.1CH IN connector will be
played back.
%
•This item can be set for input sources for which “HDMI” or “DIGITAL” is
assigned at “Input Assign” (vpage 179).
•Normally set this mode to “Auto”. It is recommended to set “PCM” or “DTS”
when audio is missing at the beginning or a noise occurs.
%
•When digital signals are properly input, the ~ indicator lights on the display.
If the ~ indicator does not light, check “Input Assign” (vpage 179) and
the connections.
•If “HDMI Control” is set to “On” and a TV compatible with the ARC is
connected via the HDMI MONITOR connectors, the input mode whose input
source is “TV AUDIO” is fixed to ARC.
•The sound mode cannot be set if the input mode is set to “7.1CH IN”.
Front panel
Appendix
Display
Rear panel
182
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Speakers
The acoustic characteristics of the connected speakers and listening room are measured and the optimum settings are made automatically. This is called
“Audyssey® Setup”.
You do not have to perform Audyssey® Setup when you have already performed Speaker Calibration in Setup Assistant.
To set up the speakers manually, use “Manual Setup” (vpage 192) on the menu.
Audyssey® Setup
NOTE
•Make the room as quiet as possible. Background noise can disrupt the room
measurements. Close windows and turn off the power on electronic devices
(TVs, radios, air conditioners, fluorescent lights, etc.). The measurements could be
affected by the sounds emitted by such devices.
•During the measurement process, place cell phones outside the listening room.
Cell phone signals could disrupt the measurements.
•Do not stand between the speakers and Setup and measurement microphone or
allow obstacles in the path while the measurements are being made. Do not hold
the Setup and measurement microphone in your hand during measurements. This
will cause inaccurate readings.
•During the measurement process, audible test tones will come from the speakers
and subwoofer(s), but this is part of normal operation. If there is background noise
in the room, these test signals will increase in volume.
•Operating VOLUME df on the remote control unit or VOLUME on the main unit
during the measurements will cancel the measurements.
•Measurement cannot be performed when headphones are connected. Unplug the
headphones before performing Audyssey® Setup.
To perform measurement, place the Setup and measurement microphone
in multiple locations all around the listening area. For best results, we
recommend you measure in six or more positions, as shown in the
illustration (up to eight positions).
%
•When performing Audyssey® Setup, Audyssey MultEQ® XT32/Audyssey Dynamic
EQ®/Audyssey Dynamic Volume®/Audyssey LFC™ functions become active
(vpage 167, 168, 169).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
183
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22About Setup and measurement microphone
placement
GExample wH
FL SW C
FL SW C
FR
( : Measuring positions)
SL
*M
The main listening position is the position where listeners would
normally sit or where one would normally sit alone within the listening
environment. Before starting Audyssey® Setup, place the Setup and
measurement microphone in the main listening position. Audyssey
MultEQ® XT32 uses the measurements from this position to calculate
speaker distance, level, polarity, and the optimum crossover value for
the subwoofer.
FL Front speaker (L)
FR Front speaker (R)
C Center speaker
Front panel
22About Audyssey Sub EQ HT™
Audyssey Sub EQ HT™ makes the integration of dual subwoofers
seamless by first compensating for any level and delay differences
between the two subwoofers and then applying Audyssey MultEQ®
XT32 to both subwoofers together.
To run Audyssey Sub EQ HT™ you must select “Measure (2 spkrs)” in
“Channel Select” (vpage 186).
FR
( : Measuring positions)
SL
SR
*M
SR
SW Subwoofer
SL Surround speaker (L)
SR Surround speaker (R)
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
22About the main listening position (*M)
•Measurements are performed by placing the Setup and measurement
microphone successively at multiple positions throughout the entire
listening area, as shown in GExample qH.
•Even if the listening environment is small as shown in GExample wH,
measuring at multiple points throughout the listening environment
results in more effective correction.
GExample qH
Tips
184
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Procedure for speaker settings
(Audyssey® Setup)
1
Tips
Mount the Setup and measurement microphone on a
tripod or stand and place it in the main listening position.
When you set the setup microphone, point the tip of it toward the
ceiling, at the height of your ears in your listening position.
Preparation
2
Measurement
If using a subwoofer capable of the following
adjustments, set up the subwoofer as shown below.
nn When using a subwoofer with a direct mode
Set the direct mode to “On” and disable the volume adjustment
and crossover frequency setting.
Calculation
nn When using a subwoofer without a direct mode
Make the following settings:
•Volume : “12 o’clock position”
•Crossover frequency : “Maximum/Highest Frequency”
•Low pass filter : “Off”
•Standby mode : “Off”
Check
Store
Finish
Front panel
Display
Appendix
Rear panel
185
Remote
Index
Contents
3
Connections
Playback
Settings
Connect the Setup and measurement microphone to
the SETUP MIC jack of this unit.
When the Setup and measurement
microphone is connected, the
following screen is displayed.
Tips
4
Select “Start” and then press ENTER.
5
Select “Next” and then press ENTER.
Audyssey® Setup can also make the following settings.
•Amp Assign
The signals output from the SURROUND BACK, FRONT
HEIGHT and FRONT WIDE speaker terminals can be switched
in accordance with your speaker environment. Refer to “Amp
Assign” (vpage 192).
•Channel Select
If channels that are not to be used are set in advance,
measurement for the set channels is skipped, and measuring
time can be reduced. You can also change the number of surround
back speakers and subwoofer.
Audyssey Setup
Your AV receiver can automatically measure the acoustics of
your room then optimize your speakers using the included
microphone.
Set the following items
if necessary.
Amp Assign
Channel Select
Check Results
Restore...
Start
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
186
Appendix
Remote
Index
Contents
6
Connections
Playback
Settings
Select “Begin Test” and then press ENTER.
•Measurement requires several minutes.
NOTE
•If “Caution!” is displayed on TV screen:
Go to “Error messages” (vpage 190). Check any related items, and
perform the necessary procedures.
•If the volume level for the subwoofer is not appropriate, an error message
is displayed. See “Subwoofer level error message and how to adjust”
(vpage 191).
Appendix
8
Select “Next” and then press ENTER.
9
Move the Setup and measurement microphone to
position 2, select “Continue”, and then press ENTER.
The measurement of the second position starts. Measurements
can be made in up to eight positions.
Audyssey Setup
Place the microphone at ear level at the 2nd listening position,
then select “Continue”...
nn When measuring has stopped
q Press BACK to display the popup screen.
wPress o to select “Yes”, and then press ENTER.
7
Tips
The detected speakers are displayed.
Continue
Calculation
Back
Audyssey Setup
Speaker Detection
Front
Center
Subwoofer
Surround
Surr. Back
Front Height
Front Wide
Repeat Last Test
Front panel
%
:Yes
:Yes
:1 spkr
:Yes
:No
:No
:No
Display
•To skip measuring the second and subsequent listening position, use i to
select “Calculation” and press ENTER to proceed to step 12.
Next
Rear panel
187
Remote
Index
Contents
10
11
Connections
Playback
Settings
12
Repeat step 9, measuring positions 3 to 8.
Tips
Appendix
Use ui to select the item you want to check, and then
press ENTER.
Select “Calculation” and then press ENTER.
Audyssey Setup
Check processing results. To proceed, press “Store”.
Audyssey Setup
Calibration completed! Now calculating...Please wait.
Speaker Config.
Distances
Levels
Crossovers
50%
Store
•Subwoofers may measure a greater reported distance than
the actual distance due to added electrical delay common in
subwoofers.
•Analysis takes several minutes to complete. The more speakers
and measurement positions that there are, the more time it takes
to perform the analysis.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
188
Remote
Index
Contents
13
Connections
Playback
Settings
15
Select “Store” and then press ENTER.
Save the measurement results.
Tips
Appendix
Set Audyssey Dynamic Volume®.
Audyssey Setup
Audyssey Setup
You can set Dynamic Volume function, which automatically
adjust volume level for all content.
Check processing results. To proceed, press “Store”.
Do you want to enable?
Speaker Config.
Distances
Levels
Crossovers
Yes
No
Store
•This feature adjusts the output volume to the optimal level while
constantly monitoring the level of the audio input to the unit.
Optimal volume control is performed automatically without any
loss in the dynamism and clarity of the sound when, for example,
the volume suddenly increases for commercials shown during
television programs.
•Saving the results requires about 30 seconds.
NOTE
•During saving of measurement results, be sure not to turn off the power.
14
Unplug the Setup and measurement microphone from
the unit’s SETUP MIC jack.
NOTE
•After performing Audyssey® Setup, do not change the speaker connections or
subwoofer volume. In event of a change, perform Audyssey® Setup again.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
189
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Error messages
An error message is displayed if Audyssey® Setup could not be completed due to speaker placement, the measurement environment, etc. If an error
message is displayed, check the relevant items and perform the necessary measures. Be sure to turn off the power before checking speaker connections.
Examples
Error details
Measures
Microphone or Speaker is
None
•Setup and measurement microphone is not
detected.
•Not all speakers could be detected.
•Connect the included Setup and measurement microphone to the
SETUP MIC jack of this unit.
•Check the speaker connections.
Ambient noise is too high or
level is too low
•There is too much noise in the room.
•Speaker or subwoofer sound is too low.
•Either turn off any device generating noise or move it away.
•Perform again when the surroundings are quieter.
•Check the speaker installation and the direction in which the
speakers are facing.
•Adjust the subwoofer’s volume.
Front R : None
•The displayed speaker could not be
detected.
•Check the connections of the displayed speaker.
Front R : Phase
•The displayed speaker is connected with
the polarity reversed.
•Check the polarity of the displayed speaker.
•For some speakers, this error message may be displayed even if
the speaker is properly connected. If you are sure the connection is
correct, use p to select “Skip Error”, then press ENTER.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
190
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Subwoofer level error message and how to
adjust
The optimal level of each subwoofer channel for Audyssey Setup
measurement is 75 dB.
During subwoofer level measurement (vpage 183 “Audyssey®
Setup”), an error message is displayed when one level of subwoofers
is outside the 72 – 78 dB range.
When using a subwoofer with built-in amplifier (active type), adjust the
subwoofer volume so that the subwoofer level is within the 72 to 78
dB range.
Tips
Appendix
1
2
Select “SW Level Matching” and then press ENTER.
3
When the measured level is within the 72 to 78 dB
range, select “Next” and then press ENTER.
Adjust the volume control on your subwoofer so that
the measured level is within the 72 to 78 dB range.
•If you use two subwoofers, the second subwoofer’s adjustment
will be started.
Repeat the operation from step 2, 3.
GError messageH
Retrieving Audyssey® Setup settings
Audyssey Setup
Your Subwoofer 1’s level is too high.
If your subwoofer has a volume control on it,
Select “SW Level Matching” to interactively adjust the level of
your subwoofer.
If you set “Restore...” to “Restore”, you can return to Audyssey® Setup
measurement result (value calculated at the start by MultEQ® XT32) even
when you have changed each setting manually.
If your subwoofer does not have a volume control,
or if you do not want to use a subwoofer, select “Skip”.
Audyssey Setup
Back
Skip
SW Level Matching
Your AV receiver can automatically measure the acoustics of
your room then optimize your speakers using the included
microphone.
Set the following items
if necessary.
Amp Assign
Channel Select
Check Results
Restore...
Start
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
191
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Manual Setup
Tips
5.1ch + ZONE2/3 : Setting to assign the unit’s built-in power amplifier
for ZONE2 and ZONE3 and output the audio in
stereo.
7.1ch(Bi-Amp) : Setting to assign the unit’s built-in power amplifier
for front speaker bi-amp connections and output the
audio in stereo.
5.1ch(Bi-Amp) + ZONE2 : Settings to use the front speakers via the
bi-amp connection and assign the internal
power amp for ZONE2 to output stereo
audio.
7.1ch + Front B : Setting to use the second set of front speakers for
playback. You can switch the speaker to be used as
the “Front Speaker” (vpage 198) between Front
speaker A and B.
Perform when setting the speakers manually or when changing settings
made in Audyssey® Setup.
•If you change the speaker settings after performing Audyssey® Setup,
it will not be possible to select Audyssey MultEQ® XT32, Audyssey
Dynamic EQ® and Audyssey Dynamic Volume® (vpage 167, 168,
169).
•“Manual Setup” can be used without changing the settings. Please set
if necessary.
Amp Assign
Select power amplifier usage method.
22Assign Mode
Set the assignment mode.
9.1ch(SB/FH/FW) (Default) : Assigns all power amplifiers within this
unit for MAIN ZONE.
7.1ch + ZONE2 : Setting to assign the unit’s built-in power amplifier for
ZONE2 and output the audio in stereo.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
192
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Main Speakers
Tips
Appendix
Speaker Config.
Selects speakers used in MAIN ZONE when “Assign Mode”
(vpage 192) is set to “7.1ch + ZONE2”, “7.1ch(Bi-Amp)” or “7.1ch
+ Front B”.
S.Back/F.Height (Default) : Uses surround back and front height
speakers.
S.Back/F.Wide : U
ses surround back and front wide speakers.
F.Height/F.Wide : U
ses front height and front wide speakers.
Indicate speaker presence and select speaker size categories based on
bass reproduction capability.
22Front
Set the front speaker size.
Large : Use a large speaker that can adequately play back very low
bass frequencies.
Small (Default) : Use a small speaker that has inadequate playback
capacity for very low bass frequencies.
%
•When “Subwoofer” is set to “None”, “Front” is automatically set to “Large”.
•When “Front” is set to “Small”, “Center”, “Surround“, “Surr. Back”, “Front
Height” and “Front Wide” can not be set to “Large”.
22Center
Set the presence and size of the center speaker.
Large : Use a large speaker that can adequately play back very low
bass frequencies.
Small (Default) : Use a small speaker that has inadequate playback
capacity for very low bass frequencies.
None : Select when a center speaker is not connected.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
193
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Subwoofer
Tips
22Surr. Back
Set the presence of a subwoofer.
2 spkrs : U
se two subwoofers.
1 spkr (Default) : Use only one subwoofer.
None : Select when a subwoofer is not connected.
Set the presence, size and number of surround back speakers.
Large : Use a large speaker that can adequately play back very low
bass frequencies.
Small (Default) : Use a small speaker that has inadequate playback
capacity for very low bass frequencies.
None : Select when the surround back speakers are not connected.
%
•When “Front” is set to “Small”, “Subwoofer” is automatically set to
“1 spkr”.
2 spkrs (Default) : Use two surround back speakers.
1 spkr : Use only one surround back speaker. When you select this
setting, connect the surround back speaker to the left (L)
channel.
22Surround
Set the presence and size of the surround speakers.
Large : Use a large speaker that can adequately play back very low
bass frequencies.
Small (Default) : Use a small speaker that has inadequate playback
capacity for very low bass frequencies.
None : Select when the surround speakers are not connected.
%
•When “Assign Mode” (vpage 192) setting is “9.1ch(SB/FH/FW)”, “7.1ch
+ ZONE2”, “7.1ch(Bi-Amp)” or “7.1ch + Front B”, you can make the “Surr.
Back” setting.
%
•When “Surround” is set to “None”, “Surr. Back”, “Front Height” and “Front
Wide” are automatically set to “None”.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
194
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Front Height
Tips
Distances
Set the presence and size of the front height speakers.
Large : Use a large speaker that can adequately play back very low
bass frequencies.
Small (Default) : Use a small speaker that has inadequate playback
capacity for very low bass frequencies.
None : Select when the front height speakers are not connected.
Set distance from listening position to speakers.
Measure beforehand the distance from the listening position to each
speaker.
22Unit
Set the unit of distance.
Feet (Default)
Meters
%
•When “Assign Mode” (vpage 192) setting is “9.1ch(SB/FH/FW)”,
“7.1ch + ZONE2”, “7.1ch(Bi-Amp)” or “7.1ch + Front B”, you can make the
“Surr. Back” setting.
22Step
Set the minimum variable width of the distance.
1ft (Default) / 0.1ft
0.1m / 0.01m
22Front Wide
Set the presence and size of the front wide speakers.
Large : Use a large speaker that can adequately play back very low
bass frequencies.
Small (Default) : Use a small speaker that has inadequate playback
capacity for very low bass frequencies.
None : Select when the front wide speakers are not connected.
%
•When “Assign Mode” (vpage 192) setting is “9.1ch(SB/FH/FW)”,
“7.1ch + ZONE2”, “7.1ch(Bi-Amp)” or “7.1ch + Front B”, you can make the
“Surr. Back” setting.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
195
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Set Defaults
Tips
Appendix
Levels
The “Distances” settings are returned to the default settings.
Set the volume of the test tone to be the same when it is output from
each speaker.
22Set the distance
0.0ft – 60.0ft / 0.00m – 18.00m
22Test Tone Start
Output test tone. A test tone is output from the selected speaker.
While listening to the test tone, adjust the volume output from the
selected speaker.
–12.0dB – +12.0dB (Default : 0.0dB)
%
•The speakers that can be selected differ depending on the “Amp Assign”
(vpage 192) and “Speaker Config.” (vpage 193) settings.
•Default settings :
Front L / Front R / F. Height L / F. Height R / F. Wide L / F. Wide R / Center /
Subwoofer : 12.0 ft (3.60 m)
Surround L / Surround R / Surr. Back L / Surr. Back R : 10.0 ft (3.00 m)
•Set the difference in the distance between the speakers to less than 20.0 ft
(6.00 m).
%
•When “Levels” is adjusted, the adjusted values are set for all the sound
modes.
•When headphones are connected to the PHONES connector on this unit, you
cannot set “Levels”.
22Set Defaults
The “Levels” settings are returned to the default settings.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
196
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
22Set the crossover frequency
Crossovers
40Hz / 60Hz / 80Hz (Default) / 90Hz / 100Hz / 110Hz / 120Hz / 150Hz /
200Hz / 250Hz
Set in accordance with the lower limit frequency of the base frequencies
that can be played back through each speaker.
%
22Speaker Selection
•“Crossovers” can be set when the “Subwoofer Mode” (vpage 198)
setting is “LFE+Main”, or when you have a speaker that is set to “Small”.
•The default crossover frequency is “80Hz”, which will work best with the
widest variety of speakers. However, we recommend setting to a higher
frequency that the crossover frequency when small speakers are used. For
example, set to “250Hz” when the frequency range of the speakers is 250
Hz – 20 kHz.
•For speakers set to “Small”, low frequency content below the crossover
frequency is attenuated to the speakers and the low bass content is then
re-delivered to the subwoofer, or the front (L/R) speakers if they have been
set to Large.
•The speakers that can be set when “Individual” is selected differ depending
on to the “Subwoofer Mode” (vpage 198) setting.
•When “LFE” is selected, speakers set to “Small” at “Speaker Config.”
(vpage 193) can be set. If the speakers are set to “Large”, “Full Band” is
displayed and the setting cannot be made.
•When “LFE+Main” is selected, speakers can be set regardless of the
“Speaker Config.” (vpage 193) setting.
Selects how to set the crossover frequency. See the speaker manual
for information concerning speaker crossover frequency.
All (Default) : S
ets the same crossover frequency for all speakers.
Individual : S
elects the crossover points for each speaker individually.
Front panel
Tips
Display
Rear panel
197
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Bass
Appendix
Impedance
Set subwoofer and LFE signal range playback.
Set the impedance of connected speakers.
8Ω/ohms (Default) : Select when the impedance per speaker for all the
connected speakers is 8 Ω/ohms or larger.
6Ω/ohms : Select when the impedance for any of the connected speakers
is between 6 Ω/ohms and 8 Ω/ohms.
22Subwoofer Mode
Select low range signals to be reproduced by subwoofer.
LFE (Default) : The low range signal of the channel set to “Small”
speaker size is added to the LFE signal output from the
subwoofer.
LFE+Main : The low range signal of all channels is added to the LFE
signal output from the subwoofer. This is usually the best
setting for most systems.
%
•Check the speaker impedance (Ω/ohms) shown on the back of your speakers or in
the instruction manual beforehand.
Front Speaker
%
•“Subwoofer Mode” can be set when “Speaker Config.” – “Subwoofer”
(vpage 194) is set to other than “None”.
•Play music or a movie source and select the mode offering the strongest
bass.
•If “Front” and “Center” for “Speaker Config.” (vpage 193) are set to
“Large”, and “Subwoofer Mode” is set to “LFE”, no sound may be output
from the subwoofers, depending on the input signal or selected sound mode.
Select “LFE+Main” if you want the bass signals to always be produced from
the subwoofer.
Set the front speaker A/B to use for every sound mode.
%
•This can be set when “Assign Mode” (vpage 192) is set to “7.1ch + Front B”.
A (Default) : Front speaker A is used.
B : Front speaker B is used.
A+B : Both front speakers A and B are used.
22LPF for LFE
%
Set LFE signal playback range. Set this when you want to change the
playback frequency (low pass filter point) of the subwoofer.
80Hz / 90Hz / 100Hz / 110Hz / 120Hz (Default) / 150Hz / 200Hz / 250Hz
Front panel
Tips
Display
Rear panel
•This can be set by pressing SPKR A/B on the main unit.
198
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Network
To use this unit by connecting it to a home network (LAN), you must configure network settings.
If you set up your home network (LAN) via DHCP, set “DHCP” to “On” (use the default setting). This allows this unit to use your home network (LAN).
When assigning an IP address to each device manually, you need to assign an IP address to this unit using the “IP Address” settings, and enter
information about your home network (LAN) such as the gateway address and subnet mask, etc.
Information
Friendly Name
Display network information.
Friendly Name / DHCP On or Off / IP Address / MAC Address
The Friendly Name is the name of this unit displayed on the network. You
can change the Friendly Name according to your preferences.
%
22Edit Name
Edits Friendly Name.
•MAC Address is required to make a vTuner account.
%
•The default Friendly Name on first use is “Marantz SR7008”.
•Up to 63 characters can be input.
•For character input, see page 159.
IP Control
Enables network communication in standby power mode.
Off In Standby : S
uspend network function during standby.
Always On (Default) : Network is on during standby. Main unit operable
with a network compatible controller.
22Set Defaults
Restores Friendly Name, which you had changed, to the default setting.
%
•When using the web control function or Marantz Remote App, use with the “IP
Control” setting set to “Always On”.
NOTE
•When “IP Control” is set to “Always On”, it consumes more standby power.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
199
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
22IP Address
Settings
Set the IP address within the ranges shown below.
•The Network Audio function cannot be used if other IP addresses
are set.
CLASS A: 10.0.0.1 – 10.255.255.254
CLASS B: 172.16.0.1 – 172.31.255.254
CLASS C: 192.168.0.1 – 192.168.255.254
Make settings for wired LAN.
•If you are using a broadband router (DHCP function), there is no need
to make the settings at “IP Address” and “Proxy”, since the DHCP
function is set to “On” in this unit’s default settings.
•Only set “Settings” when connecting to a network without a DHCP
function.
22Subnet Mask
When connecting an xDSL modem or connector adapter directly to this
unit, input the subnet mask indicated in the documentation supplied by
your provider. Normally input 255.255.255.0.
Network/Settings
DHCP
-IP Address
-Subnet Mask
-Default Gateway
-Primary DNS
-Secondary DNS
Proxy
-Address
-Port
Save
Cancel
Configure the network
Off
192.168.000.001
255.255.255.000
255.255.255.000
000.000.000.000
000.000.000.000
Off
000.000.000.000
00000
22Default Gateway
When connected to a gateway (router), input its IP address.
22Primary DNS, Secondary DNS
If there is only one DNS address indicated in the documentation
supplied by your provider, input it at “Primary DNS”. If two or more
DNS are provided by your provider, enter both “Primary DNS” and
“Secondary DNS”.
settings manually
22DHCP
Selects how to connect to the network.
On (Default) : Configure the network settings automatically from your
router.
Off : C
onfigure the network settings manually.
Front panel
Appendix
Display
Rear panel
200
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Proxy
Used to check the network connection.
22Physical Connection
Checks the physical LAN port connection.
OK
Error : The LAN cable is not connected. Check the connection.
22Router Access
Checks the connection from this unit to the router.
OK
Error : Failed to communicate with the router. Check the router
settings.
22Port
Enter port number.
%
•If you cannot connect to the Internet, recheck the connections and settings
(vpage 53).
•If you do not understand about Internet connection, contact your ISP (Internet
Service Provider) or the store from which you purchased your computer.
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Diagnostics
Make this setting when connecting to the Internet via a proxy server.
Make the proxy settings only when you connect to the Internet via
a proxy server that is on your internal network or provided by your
provider, etc.
On(Address) : S
elect when inputting by address.
On(Name) : Select when inputting by domain name. Up to 38
characters can be input.
Off (Default) : D
isables the proxy server.
Front panel
Tips
22Internet Access
Checks whether this unit has access to the Internet (WAN).
OK
Error : Failed to connect to the Internet. Check the Internet connection
environment or router settings.
201
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Maintenance Mode
Use when receiving maintenance from a Marantz service engineer or
custom installer. Ordinarily, this mode isn’t suitable for use by the end user,
only by a trained service technician or custom installation professional.
NOTE
•Only use this function if so instructed by a Marantz serviceperson or installer.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
202
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
General
Make various other settings.
Language
ZONE2 Setup / ZONE3 Setup
Set the language for display the menu on the TV screen.
English (Default) / Français / Español
Set the audio to play back with multi-zone (ZONE2, ZONE3).
%
•Values set for “Volume Limit” and “Power On Volume” are displayed according to
the setting specified for the volume “Scale” (vpage 166).
%
•“Language” can also be set by the following procedure. However, the menu
screen is not displayed.
Following the display content to make the setting.
1.Press and hold the main unit’s STATUS and ZONE SELECT for at least 3
seconds.
“zVideo Format <NTSC>” appears on the display.
2. Press the main unit’s i.
“zGUI Language <ENGLISH>” appears on the display.
3. Use the main unit’s o p and set the language.
4. Press the main unit’s ENTER to complete the setting.
22Bass
Adjust bass.
–14dB – +14dB (Default : 0dB)
22Treble
Adjust treble.
–14dB – +14dB (Default : 0dB)
22High Pass Filter
Make settings for cutting the low range to reduce distortion in the bass.
On : The low range is attenuated.
Off (Default) : The low range is not attenuated.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
203
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Lch Level
Appendix
22Volume Level
Adjust the left channel output level.
–12dB – +12dB (Default : 0dB)
Set the volume output level.
Variable (Default) : Volume can be adjusted.
1 – 98 (–79dB – 18dB) : Volume is fixed at the desired level. The
volume cannot be adjusting using the remote
control unit.
22Rch Level
Adjust the right channel output level.
–12dB – +12dB (Default : 0dB)
22Volume Limit
Make a setting for maximum volume.
60 (–20dB) / 70 (–10dB) / 80 (0dB) (Default : 70 (–10dB))
Off : Do not set a maximum volume.
22Channel
Set whether to playback in stereo or monaural.
Stereo (Default) : S
tereo playback.
Mono : M
onaural playback.
%
•This can be set when “Volume Level” is set to “Variable”.
%
22Power On Volume
•When “Assign Mode” (vpage 192) is set to “5.1ch + ZONE2/3”, the
“Channel” setting is automatically set to “Mono”.
Define the volume setting that is active when the power is turned on.
Last (Default) : Use the memorized setting from the last session.
Mute : Always mute when power is turned on.
1 – 98 (–79dB – 18dB) : The volume is adjusted to the set level.
22HDMI Audio (ZONE2 only)
Selects the audio signal format for playing an HDMI source in ZONE2.
Through (Default) : The HDMI audio signal is passed through the AV
receiver to the device in ZONE2.
PCM : The HDMI audio signal input into this unit is converted to a PCM
signal that can be output from the ZONE2 PRE OUT terminals
or speaker terminals.
Front panel
Tips
Display
Rear panel
%
•This can be set when “Volume Level” is set to “Variable”.
204
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Mute Level
Tips
Appendix
Trigger Out 1 / Trigger Out 2
Set the amount of attenuation when muting is on.
Full (Default) : T
he sound is muted entirely.
–40dB : The sound is attenuated by 40 dB down.
–20dB : The sound is attenuated by 20 dB down.
Selects when to activate trigger out.
For details about how to connect the DC OUT jacks, see “DC OUT jack”
(vpage 57).
%
nn When setting for zone (MAIN ZONE / ZONE2 / ZONE3)
Trigger out is activated through linkage to the power of the zone set
to “On”.
•This can be set when “Volume Level” is set to “Variable”.
nn When setting for input source
Activate trigger out when the input source set to “On” is selected.
Zone Rename
Change the display title of each zone to one you prefer.
MAIN ZONE / ZONE2 / ZONE3
Set Defaults : T
he input source name is returned to the default setting.
nn When setting for HDMI monitor
Activate trigger out when the HDMI monitor set to “On” is selected.
%
On : Activate trigger on this mode.
– – – : Do not activate trigger on this mode.
•Up to 10 characters can be input.
•For character input, see page 159.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
205
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
22Channel Indicators
Auto Standby
Sets whether to use the input signal display or output signal display for
the channel indication on the display.
Input : Uses the input signal display for the channel indication on the
display.
Output (Default) : Uses the output signal display for the channel
indication on the display.
Sets the time after which the unit automatically enters standby mode
when there are no audio or video signals input, and the unit is not operated.
Before it enters the standby mode, “Auto Standby” is displayed on the
display of this unit and the menu screen.
60 min : T
he unit goes into standby after 60 minutes.
30 min : T
he unit goes into standby after 30 minutes.
Off (Default) : T
he unit does not go into standby automatically.
Front Display
Makes settings related to the display on this unit.
22Display
Select the front display mode.
On (Default) : Display is always on.
Auto Off : D
isplay is off except when showing the status display.
Off : D
isplay is always off.
%
•This can be set by pressing DISPLAY on the main unit.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
206
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22Video
Information
Show information about receiver settings, input signals, etc.
Show the HDMI input/output signals and HDMI monitor information
for MAIN ZONE.
22Audio
HDMI Signal Info.
Resolution / Color Space / Pixel Depth
Show the audio information for MAIN ZONE.
Sound Mode : T
he currently set sound mode.
Input Signal : T
he input signal type.
Format : The number of input signal channels (presence of front,
surround, LFE).
Sample Rate : T
he input signal’s sampling frequency.
Offset : T
he dialogue normalization correction value.
Flag : This is displayed when inputting signals including a surround
back channel. “MATRIX” is displayed with Dolby Digital EX
and DTS-ES Matrix signals, “DISCRETE” with DTS-ES Discrete
signals.
HDMI Monitor 1 / HDMI Monitor 2
Interface / Resolutions
22ZONE
Show information about current settings.
MAIN ZONE : This item shows information about settings for MAIN
ZONE. The information displayed differs according to
the input source.
ZONE2 : This item shows information about settings for ZONE2.
ZONE3 : This item shows information about settings for ZONE3.
Dialogue normalization function
This function is automatically activated when playing Dolby Digital,
Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby TrueHD, DTS and DTS-HD sources.
It automatically corrects the standard signal level for individual
program sources.
The correction value can be checked using the main unit’s STATUS.
22Firmware
Version : Displays information for the current firmware.
Dial.Norm
Offset - 4dB
The figure is the corrected value. This cannot be changed.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
207
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Notifications
Tips
Usage Data
Displays and sets notifications from Marantz.
Also, sets whether or not to display the notification when the power
is turned on.
To help us improve our products and customer service, Marantz collects
anonymous information about how you use your AV receiver (such as
frequently used input sources and sound modes and speaker settings).
Marantz will never provide any information we collect to third parties.
Yes : Provide Marantz with information about how you use this unit via
the network.
No : Do not provide Marantz with information about how you use this unit
via the network.
Notification Alerts
On (Default) : Displays notification messages from Marantz.
Off : D
oes not display notification messages from Marantz.
%
•Press INFO on the remote control unit to display current source name, volume,
sound mode name, and other information at the bottom of the screen.
SOURCE
SOUND
SIGNAL
Blu-ray
DOLBY TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD
INPUT SIGNAL
FWL
SL
FHL
EXT
FHR
SBL
SB
SBR
FL
C
LFE
FR
ACTIVE SPEAKERS
FWR
SR
SL
FL
SBL
C
SW1
FR
SBR
SR
40.0
NOTE
•The status display screen cannot be displayed at a computer’s resolution (e.g. VGA)
is being played.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
208
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
22Notifications
Firmware
When the latest firmware is available, a notification message is
displayed on the TV screen at power on.
The notification message is displayed for about 20 seconds when the
power is turned on. Connect to broadband Internet (vpage 53)
when using this function.
Checks for the latest firmware information about updates and upgrades,
updates the firmware, and sets up the notification message display for
updates and upgrades.
22Update
Update
Update the firmware of the receiver.
On (Default) : Display update message.
Off : Do not display update message.
Check for Update : Check for firmware updates. You can also check
approximately how long it will take to complete
an update.
Update Start : Execute the update process. When the update starts,
the menu screen is shut down. During the update, the
progress is shown on the display.
Upgrade
On (Default) : Display upgrade message.
Off : Do not display upgrade message.
%
•If updating fails, the set automatically retries, but if updating is still not
possible, one of the messages shown below is displayed. If the display reads
as shown below, check the settings and network environment, then update
again.
Display
Updating fail
Login failed
Server is busy
Connection fail
Download fail
Front panel
Description
Updating failed.
Failure to log into server.
Server is busy. Wait a while then try again.
Failure in connecting to server.
Downloading of the firmware has failed.
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
209
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Add New Feature
•In order to use these functions, you must have the correct system
requirements and settings for a broadband Internet connection
(vpage 53).
•Do not turn off the power until updating or upgrading is completed.
•Even with a broadband connection to the Internet, approximately 1
hour is required for the updating/upgrading procedure to be completed.
•Once updating/upgrade starts, normal operations on this unit cannot
be performed until updating/upgrading is completed. Furthermore,
there may be cases where backup data is reset for the parameters,
etc., set on this unit.
•If the update or upgrade fails, press and hold the X on the main unit
for more than 5 seconds, or remove and re-insert the power cord.
“Update retry” appears on the display and update restarts from the
point at which update failed. If the error continues despite this, check
the network environment.
%
•See the Marantz website for details about upgrades.
•When the procedure is complete, “Registered” is displayed in this menu and
upgrades can be carried out. If the procedure has not been carried out, “Not
Registered” is displayed.
The ID number shown on this screen is needed when carrying out the
procedure.
The ID number can also be displayed by pressing and holding the main unit’s o
and SETUP for at least 3 seconds.
•If the upgrade is not successful, an error message identical to those in
“Update” will appear on the display. Check the settings and network
environment and then perform the upgrade again.
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Notes concerning use of “Update” and “Add New Feature”
Display new features that can be downloaded to this unit and perform
an upgrade.
Upgrade Package : D
isplay the items to be upgraded.
Upgrade Status : Display a list of the additional functions provided by
the upgrade.
Upgrade Start : Execute the upgrade process. When the upgrade
starts, the menu screen is shut down. During the
upgrade, the amount of upgrade time which has
elapsed is displayed.
Front panel
Tips
%
•Information regarding the “Update” function and “Add New Feature” will be
announced on the Marantz web site each time related plans are defined.
210
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Setup Lock
Protect settings from inadvertent changes.
22Lock
On : Turn protection on.
Off (Default) : T
urn protection off.
%
•When cancelling the setting, set “Lock” to “Off”.
NOTE
•When “Lock” is set to “On”, no setting items are displayed except for “Setup
Lock”.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
211
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Operating external devices with the remote control unit
SET
When preset codes are registered in the included remote control unit, it
can then be used to operate any devices you have, such as DVD players
or TVs made by different manufacturers.
AVR
Input source
select buttons
CH/PAGE d
OPTION
ENTER
INFO
FAVORITE
STATION
1–4
0–9
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
212
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22Registering Marantz players
Registering preset codes
Use the following simple method to register the preset codes of
Marantz Blu-ray Disc players, DVD players and CD players.
There are three methods for registering preset codes; the simple method
for registering preset codes of Marantz players, the method for registering
the preset numbers of other manufacturers’ devices, and the method for
experimenting with preset codes one by one for registration.
•Registering Marantz players (vpage 213)
•Registering by entering preset numbers (vpage 214)
•Delete remote control codes for each button (vpage 221)
nn Registering Blu-ray Disc players
1
Press and hold down Blu-ray and OPTION until “OK”
indicator on the remote control display is flashing, then
release.
nn Registering DVD players
1
Press and hold down DVD and OPTION until “OK”
indicator on the remote control display is flashing, then
release.
nn Registering CD players
1
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
213
Press and hold down CD and OPTION until “OK”
indicator on the remote control display is flashing, then
release.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Before starting, confirm the preset number of the device that you want
to register and the buttons that can be registered in the Preset Code
Table (vpage 279) in the Appendix.
Press and hold down the FAVORITE STATION 1 – 4 and
OPTION until “OK” indicator on the remote control
display is flashing, then release.
Devices to be registered at the same time
Bru-ray Disc
DVD player
CD player
player
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
Press and
hold down
the buttons
FAVORITE
STATION 1
and
OPTION
FAVORITE
STATION 2
and
OPTION
FAVORITE
STATION 3
and
OPTION
FAVORITE
STATION 4
and
OPTION
1
Press and hold down the input source select button
that you want to register the preset code to and SET
until “PRSET” indicator on the remote control display is
flashing, then release.
2
Enter the preset number (4 digits) listed for the device in
the Preset Code Table using the number buttons (0 – 9)
on the remote control.
%
•Some manufacturers use more than one type of remote control code. Preset codes
to change the number and verify correct operation.
NOTE
•Depending on the model and year of manufacture of your device, some buttons
may not operate.
NOTE
•Depending on the model and year of manufacture of your device, some buttons
may not operate. In this case, try “Registering by entering preset numbers”
(vpage 214).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
22Registering by entering preset numbers
nn Registering multiple players at the same time
1
Tips
214
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Experimenting with preset codes one by one
for registration
1
Switch the power on of the device for which you want
to set the preset code.
2
Press and hold down the input source select button
that you want to register the preset code to and SET
until “PRSET” indicator on the remote control display is
flashing, then release.
3
Tips
%
•Some manufacturers use more than one type of remote control code. Preset codes
to change the number and verify correct operation.
•If the AV device is not a Marantz device, or if the device does not operate even
when the preset code is registered, use the learning function. Remote codes
for different devices can be remembered for use by the Marantz remote control
included with this device.
NOTE
•Depending on the model and year of manufacture of your device, some buttons
may not operate.
Aim the remote control at the appliance and slowly
alternate between pressing CH/PAGE d and DEVICE X
for the appliance.
The preset code is shown in the remote control display.
4
5
Stop when the appliance turns off.
Press ENTER once to lock in the code.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
215
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
nn TV group
(TV) operation
Operating devices
To operate an external device, press the input source button registered
with the preset code, followed by one of the buttons in the following
tables.
Operation
buttons
TV X
TV INPUT
CH/PAGE df
%
•When operating an external device, the display on the remote control unit shows
the input source name.
•When operating TV, the display on the remote control unit shows “TV”.
•The “TV” indicator lights when the TV is being operated.
•To operate the menu of this unit, press AVR before operating the unit. The “AVR”
operation mode indicator lights when this unit is being operated.
Function
TV power on/off
Switch TV input
Switch channels (up/down)
%
•TV X and TV INPUT buttons can be operated at any time without pressing the TV
button.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
216
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
nn DVD group
(DVD player / DVD recorder) operation
Operation
buttons
DEVICE X
DEVICE MENU
INFO
OPTION
uio p
ENTER
BACK
SETUP
2
3
1
8 9
6 7
0 – 9, +10
Front panel
Display
nn CD group
(CD player / CD recorder) operation
Operation
buttons
DEVICE X
DEVICE MENU
INFO
Function
Power on/off
Menu
Information
Top menu
Cursor operation
Enter
Return
Setup
Stop
Pause
Playback
Skip chapter
Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
Select title, chapter or channel
selection
Rear panel
Appendix
Tips
uio p
ENTER
2
3
1
8 9
6 7
0 – 9, +10
217
Remote
Function
Power on/off
Menu
Information
Cursor operation
Enter
Stop
Pause
Playback
Skip track
Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
Track selection
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
nn CBL/SAT group
(Set top box for satellite (SAT) / cable (CBL) / Media
player) operation
Operation
buttons
DEVICE X
DEVICE MENU
CH/PAGE df
INFO
uio p
ENTER
BACK
SETUP
3
1
8 9
6 7
0 – 9, +10
nn BD group
(Blu-ray Disc player) operation
Operation
buttons
DEVICE X
DEVICE MENU
INFO
OPTION
Function
Power on/off
Menu
Switch channels (up/down)
Information
Cursor operation
Enter
Return
Setup
Pause
Playback
Skip chapter
Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
Channel selection
uio p
ENTER
BACK
SETUP
HOME
2
3
1
8 9
6 7
0 – 9, +10
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Tips
218
Remote
Function
Power on/off
(Popup) Menu
Information
Top menu
Cursor operation
Enter
Return
Setup
Go to Home screen
Stop
Pause
Playback
Skip chapter
Fast-reverse / Fast-forward
Select title, chapter or channel
selection
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Check the registered preset code
1
Press and hold an input source select button for which
you want to check the preset code and the SET button
until the display on the remote control unit shows
“PRSET”.
2
Press INFO.
Tips
Initializing registered preset codes
1
Press and hold down AVR and OPTION until “OK”
indicator on the remote control display is flashing, then
release.
The set code is shown for 3 seconds in the remote control display.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
219
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Operating learn function
If the device does not operate even when the preset code is registered,
use the learning function. Remote codes for different devices can be
remembered for use by the Marantz remote control included with this
device.
SET
Remembering remote control codes
from other devices
TV AUDIO
CBL/SAT
DVD
Blu-ray
AUX1
GAME
AUX2
MEDIA PLAYER
CD
1
Place the Marantz remote control and remote control
from the other device approximately 5 cm apart, with
the remote control signal transmission sections facing
each other.
2
3
Press and hold SET until the LEARN indicator blinks.
The input source is shown in the remote control display.
4
Front panel
Press input source select buttons to select the input
source.
Display
Rear panel
220
Select the button to be learned.
LEARN indicator lights up.
Remote
Index
Contents
5
Connections
Playback
Settings
Codes can be erased in three ways: by buttons, sources, and by all
memory contents.
•If “NG” is shown on the remote control display, perform step 4
again.
Repeat steps 4 and 5 to learn other buttons for the same
input source.
7
When programming of the remote control unit is
completed, press SET.
22Delete remote control codes for each button
1
2
Press and hold SET until the LEARN indicator blinks.
Press input source select buttons to select the input
source you want to delete.
The input source is shown in the remote control display.
The LEARN indicator turns off, and the remote control unit exits
learn mode.
3
%
Press and hold POWER X and press the learned button
to be erased twice.
“ERASE” is shown in the remote control display.
•There are some remote control units that cannot be programmed, or even if they
can be programmed, they may not operate correctly. If this happens, use the
remote control unit supplied with the AV equipment to operate it.
•If the remote control memory becomes full, “FULL” is shown on the remote control
display. If you want to learn the code, you should erase other learned button.
4
Press SET.
•The LEARN indicator turn off.
NOTE
•The learning function is unavailable for all ZONE SELECT, SET, AVR, POWER
X, VOLUME df, FAVORITE STATION, SOUND MODE and input source select
buttons in any mode.
•If no buttons are pressed for approximately 1 minutes while in the LEARN mode,
the remote control unit automatically exits from the LEARN mode.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Delete saved remote control codes
Press and hold the button that you want to register on
the other remote control until “OK” is displayed on the
Marantz remote control display.
6
Tips
221
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22Delete remote control codes for each input
source
22Delete remote control codes for all input
sources
1
2
Press and hold SET until the LEARN indicator blinks.
Press and hold POWER X and press the learned input
source select buttons to be erased twice.
1
2
Press SET.
3
Press SET.
Press and hold SET until the LEARN indicator blinks.
“ERASE” is shown in the remote control display.
3
Press and hold POWER X and press AVR twice.
“ERASE” is shown in the remote control display.
•The LEARN indicator turn off.
•The LEARN indicator turn off.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
222
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Setting the back light
You can turn off the backlight of the remote control unit.
•Backlight is set on in the factory settings.
Disabling the backlight
SET
1
Turning the backlight on
Light button
1
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Press and hold both SET and Light button until “OFF”
indicator flashes twice.
223
Press and hold both SET and Light button until “ON”
indicator flashes twice.
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Specifying the zone used with the remote control unit
When the ZONE SELECT is pressed, only the set zone can be operated
with the remote control unit.
This is useful for preventing mistaken operation.
•The factory setting is “M23”.
SET
ZONE SELECT
Display
Rear panel
Press and hold ZONE SELECT and SET for at least 3
seconds.
2
Use ui to set the zone to be used and press ENTER.
“SET” flashes four times on the remote control unit and the normal
operation mode is restored.
Remote control unit display
M
M2
M23
ui
ENTER
Front panel
1
224
Remote
Index
Zone to be used
MAIN ZONE only
MAIN ZONE / ZONE2
MAIN ZONE / ZONE2 / ZONE3
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Tips
Contents
22Tips...................................................................(226)
22Troubleshooting.............................................(228)
I want the volume not to become too loud by mistake...................(226)
Power does not turn on/Power is turned off...................................(228)
I want to keep the volume at the same level when I turn the
power on.........................................................................................(226)
Operations cannot be performed through the
remote control unit..........................................................................(229)
I want to have the subwoofer always output audio........................(226)
Display on this unit shows nothing.................................................(229)
I want to make human voices in the movies clearer.......................(226)
No sound comes out.......................................................................(230)
I want to keep bass and clarity during playback at a lower
volume level....................................................................................(226)
Desired sound does not come out..................................................(231)
I want to automatically adjust the volume level difference in
content such as TV and movies......................................................(226)
No video is shown on the TV..........................................................(234)
Sound is interrupted or noise occurs...............................................(233)
The menu screen is not displayed on the TV..................................(235)
I want to set the optimized listening environment after changing
the configuration/position of the speakers or changing a speaker
to a new one...................................................................................(226)
iPod cannot be played back.............................................................(236)
USB memory devices cannot be played back.................................(237)
File names on the iPod/USB memory device are not
displayed properly...........................................................................(238)
I want to combine a desired video with the current music.............(227)
I want to play back photos from Flickr at the same time while
listening to the Internet radio..........................................................(227)
The Internet radio cannot be played back.......................................(238)
I want to delete unused input sources............................................(227)
Music files on PC or NAS cannot be played back...........................(239)
I want to enjoy the same music in all zones at the home
party, etc.........................................................................................(227)
The HDMI control function does not work......................................(240)
When using HDMI ZONE2, the devices does not
function properly.............................................................................(240)
I want to minimize the delay in video signals when I’m playing a
game on my game console.............................................................(227)
How to add Wi-Fi to the AV receiver?.............................................(227)
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
225
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Tips
I want the volume not to become too loud by mistake.
•Set the volume upper limit for “Volume Limit” in the menu beforehand. This prevents children or others from increasing the volume too much by
mistake. You can set this for each zone (vpage 167, 204).
I want to keep the volume at the same level when I turn the power on.
•By default, the volume setting when power was previously set to standby is applied at next power on. To use a fixed volume level, set the volume level
at power on for “Volume Limit” in the menu. You can set this for each zone (vpage 167, 204).
I want to have the subwoofer always output audio.
•Depending on the input signals and sound mode, the subwoofer may not output audio.
When “Subwoofer Mode” in the menu is set to “LFE+Main”, you can have the subwoofer always output audio (vpage 198).
I want to make human voices in the movies clearer.
•Use “Dialog Level” in the menu to adjust the level (vpage 161).
I want to keep bass and clarity during playback at a lower volume level.
•Set “Dynamic EQ” in the menu to “On”. This setting corrects the frequency characteristics to allow you to enjoy clear sound without the bass being
lost even during playback at a lower volume level (vpage 168).
I want to automatically adjust the volume level difference in content such as TV and movies.
•Set “Dynamic Volume” in the menu. Volume level changes (between quiet scenes and loud scenes) in TV shows or movies are automatically adjusted
to your desired level (vpage 169).
I want to set the optimized listening environment after changing the configuration/position of the speakers or
changing a speaker to a new one.
•Perform Audyssey® Setup. This automatically makes the optimized speaker settings for the new listening environment (vpage 183).
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
226
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
I want to combine a desired video with the current music.
•Set “Video Select” in the option menu to “On”. You can combine the current music with your desired video source from Set-top Box or DVD, etc. while
listening to music from Tuner, CD, PHONO, M-XPort or the Internet radio (vpage 115).
I want to play back photos from Flickr at the same time while listening to the Internet radio.
•After playing back photos from Flickr, start the slide show on the Internet radio playback screen (vpage 114).
I want to delete unused input sources.
•Set unused input sources for “Hide Sources” in the menu. This allows you to skip unused input sources when rotating the INPUT SELECTOR knob on
this unit (vpage 181).
I want to enjoy the same music in all zones at the home party, etc.
•Set “All Zone Stereo” in the option menu to “On”. This allows you to simultaneously play back in ZONE2/ZONE3 the music that is played back in MAIN
ZONE (vpage 117).
I want to minimize the delay in video signals when I’m playing a game on my game console.
•When the video is delayed against button operations with the controller on the game console, set “Video Mode” in the menu to “Game” (vpage 175).
How to add Wi-Fi to the AV receiver?
•Connect a wireless LAN converter (sold separately) to the NETWORK connector on this unit.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
227
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Troubleshooting
If a problem should arise, first check the following:
1. Are the connections correct?
2. Is the set being operated as described in the owner’s manual?
3. Are the other devices operating properly?
If this unit does not operate properly, check the items listed in the table below. Should the problem persist, there may be a malfunction.
In this case, disconnect the power immediately and contact your store of purchase.
22Power does not turn on / Power is turned off
Symptom
Cause / Solution
Page
Power does not turn on.
•Check whether the power plug is correctly inserted into the power outlet.
58
Power automatically turns off.
•The sleep timer is set. Turn on the power again.
•“Auto Standby” is set. “Auto Standby” is triggered when there is no operation for a set
amount of time. To disable “Auto Standby”, set “Auto Standby” on the menu to “Off”.
135
206
Power turns off and the power
indicator flashes in red approx. every
2 seconds.
•The protection circuit has been activated due to a rise in temperature within this unit. Turn the
power off, wait about an hour until this unit cools down sufficiently, and then turn the power
on again.
•Please re-install this unit in a place having good ventilation.
262
Power turns off and the power
indicator flashes in red approx. every
0.5 seconds.
•Check the speaker connection. The protection circuit may have been activated because
speaker cable core wires came in contact with each other or a core wire was disconnected
from the connector and came in contact with the rear panel of this unit. After unplugging the
power cord, take corrective action such as firmly re-twisting the core wire or taking care of the
connector, and then reconnect the wire.
•Turn down the volume and turn on the power again.
•This unit’s amplifier circuit has failed. Unplug the power cord and contact our customer
service center.
32
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
228
Remote
Index
–
60, 61
–
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22Operations cannot be performed through the remote control unit
Symptom
Operations cannot be performed
through the remote control unit.
Cause/Solution
Page
•Batteries are worn out. Replace with new batteries.
•Operate the remote control unit within a distance of about 23 ft/7 m from this unit and at an
angle of within 30°.
•Remove any obstacle between this unit and the remote control unit.
•Insert the batteries in the proper direction, checking the q and w marks.
•The set’s remote control sensor is exposed to strong light (direct sunlight, inverter type
fluorescent bulb light, etc.). Move the set to a place in which the remote control sensor will
not be exposed to strong light.
•The operation target zone does not correspond to the zone setting specified on the remote
control unit. Press ZONE SELECT to select the zone to operate.
•The remote control unit operating mode is used to operate other devices. Press the AVR
button to set the operating mode to AVR.
•When using a 3D video device, the remote control unit of this unit may not function due to
effects of infrared communications between units (such as TV and glasses for 3D viewing). In
this case, adjust the direction of units with the 3D communications function and their distance
to ensure they do not affect operations from the remote control unit of this unit.
8
8
–
8
–
149, 158
216
–
22Display on this unit shows nothing
Symptom
Cause/Solution
Display is off.
Front panel
Page
206
120
•Set “Display” on the menu to something other than “Off”.
•When the sound mode is set to PURE DIRECT, the display is off.
Display
Rear panel
229
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22No sound comes out
Symptom
Cause/Solution
Page
32, 40, 41, 42,
44, 45, 46, 47,
48, 49, 51, 53,
55, 56, 57
–
•Insert connection cables all the way in.
–
•Check that input connectors and output connectors are not reversely connected.
–
•Check cables for damage.
32
•Check that speaker cables are properly connected. Check that cable core wires come in
contact with the metal part on speaker terminals. Also, securely tighten speaker terminals.
Check speaker terminals for looseness.
60, 149
•Check that a proper input source is selected.
61, 149
•Adjust the master volume.
61, 150
•Cancel the mute mode.
41, 42, 44, 45
•Check the digital input connector setting.
–
•Check the digital audio output setting on the connected device. On some devices, the digital
audio output is set to off by default.
14
•No sound is output from the speakers when headphones are connected.
No sound comes out of speakers.
•Check the connections for all devices.
No sound comes out when using the
DVI-D connection.
•When this unit is connected to a device equipped with a DVI-D connector, no sound is output.
Make a separate audio connection.
–
No sound comes out of a TV that is
connected via HDMI.
•Audio signals input to 7.1CH IN connectors on this unit cannot be output to the TV.
–
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
230
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22Desired sound does not come out
Cause/Solution
Page
The volume does not increase.
Symptom
•The maximum volume is set too low. Set the maximum volume using “Limit”on the menu.
•Appropriate volume correction processing is performed according to the input audio format
and settings, so the volume may not reach the upper limit.
167, 204
–
No sound comes out with the HDMI
connection.
•Check the connection of the HDMI connectors.
No sound comes out of a specific
speaker.
•Check that the speaker cable is properly connected.
•Check that a selection other than “None” is set for the “Speaker Config.” setting in menu.
•Check the “Assign Mode” setting in the menu.
•When the sound mode is “STEREO” and “VIRTUAL”, audio is only output from the front
speakers and subwoofer.
32
193, 194
192
–
No sound is produced from
subwoofer.
•Check the subwoofer connections.
•Turn on the subwoofer’s power.
•Set “Speaker Config.” – “Subwoofer” on the menu to “2 spkrs” or “1 spkr”.
•When “Speaker Config.” – “Front” in the menu is set to “Large”, depending on the input
signal and the sound mode, no sound may be output from the subwoofer.
•When no subwoofer audio signal (LFE) is included in the input signals, no sound may be
output from the subwoofer.
•You can make the subwoofer always output sound by setting the subwoofer mode to
“LFE+Main”.
33
–
194
193
Front panel
Display
40, 41, 44, 45,
46
173
•When outputting HDMI audio from the speakers, set “HDMI Audio Out” on the menu to
“AVR”. To output from the TV, set “TV”.
132
•When using the HDMI control function, check that the audio output is set to the AV amplifier
on the TV.
Rear panel
231
Remote
Index
198
198
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Symptom
Tips
Appendix
Cause/Solution
Page
DTS sound is not output.
•Check that the digital audio output setting on the connected device is set to “DTS”.
•Set “Decode Mode” on the menu to “Auto” or “DTS”.
Dolby TrueHD, DTS-HD, Dolby Digital
Plus audio is not output.
•Make HDMI connections.
•Check the digital audio output setting on the connected device. On some devices, “PCM” is
set by default.
–
182
44, 45, 46
–
Dolby PLg mode or DTS NEO:X mode •It cannot be selected when “None” is set for “Speaker Config.” – “Center” and “Surround”.
•These cannot be selected when using the headphones.
cannot be selected.
193
–
Audyssey MultEQ® XT32, Audyssey
Dynamic EQ®, Audyssey Dynamic
Volume® and Audyssey LFC™ cannot
be selected.
•These cannot be selected when you have not performed Audyssey® Setup.
•Switch the sound mode to other than “DIRECT” or “PURE DIRECT”.
•These cannot be selected when using the headphones.
183
120
–
Audyssey DSX® cannot be selected.
•It can be selected when using the front height or front wide speakers.
•It can be selected when using the center speaker.
•Switch the sound mode to DOLBY sound mode or DTS sound mode.
•This cannot be selected when using the headphones.
195
193
119
–
“M-DAX” cannot be selected.
•Check that an analog signal or PCM signal (Sample Rate=44.1/48 kHz) is input. For playback
of multichannel signals such as Dolby Digital or DTS surround, “M-DAX” cannot be used.
•Switch the sound mode to other than “DIRECT” or “PURE DIRECT”.
165
No audio is output from PRE OUT or
speakers for ZONE2/ZONE3.
•In ZONE2/ZONE3, the audio can be played back when signals input from digital connectors
(OPTICAL/COAXIAL) are in 2ch PCM format.
•In ZONE2, the audio can be played back when signals input from the HDMI connector are
in 2ch PCM format. To play back the audio in ZONE2 irrespective of the input signal format,
set the “HDMI Audio” setting in the menu to “PCM”. Depending on the played back device,
the audio may not be played back even with this setting. In that case, set the audio format to
“PCM (2ch)” on the played back device.
–
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
232
Remote
Index
120
204
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22Sound is interrupted or noise occurs
Cause/Solution
Page
During playback from the Internet
radio or USB memory device, sound
is occasionally interrupted.
Symptom
•When the transfer speed of the USB memory device is slow, sound may occasionally be
interrupted.
•The network communication speed is slow or the radio station is busy.
–
When making a call on iPhone, noise
occurs in audio output on this unit.
•When making a call, keep a distance of 20 cm or longer between iPhone and this unit.
–
Noise often occurs in FM/AM
broadcasting.
•Change the antenna orientation or position.
•Separate the AM loop antenna from the unit.
•Use an FM outdoor antenna.
•Separate the antenna from other connection cables.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
233
Remote
–
51
51
51
51
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22No video is shown on the TV
Symptom
Cause/Solution
Page
40, 41, 42, 44,
45, 46, 47, 48,
49, 51, 53, 55,
56, 57
–
•Insert connection cables all the way in.
–
•Check that input connectors and output connectors are not reversely connected.
–
•Check cables for damage.
179
•Match the input settings to the input connector of the TV connected to this unit.
60, 149
•Check that the proper input source is selected.
179
•Check the video input connector setting.
207
•Check that the resolution of the player corresponds to that of the TV.
244
•Check whether the TV is compatible with copyright protection (HDCP). If connected to a
device not compatible with HDCP, video will not be output correctly.
245
•The HDMI signal cannot be converted to an analog signal. Use analog connections.
No picture appears.
•Check the connections for all devices.
No video is shown on the TV with the •With the DVI-D connection, on some device combinations, devices may not function properly
DVI-D connection.
due to the copy guard copyright protection (HDCP).
No video from an input source such
as a game console is shown on the
TV.
244
•When special video signals are input from a game console, etc., the video conversion function
may not function. Connect the input connector to the monitor output connector of the same
type.
–
While the menu is being displayed, no •When the menu is operated during playback of some 3D video contents or of video at some
video is shown on the TV.
computer resolutions (such as VGA), no playback video is shown in the background of the
menu.
–
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
234
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22The menu screen is not displayed on the TV
Symptom
Cause/Solution
Page
The menu screen or status
•The menu screen is only displayed on this unit and a TV connected by HDMI cable. If this unit
information screen is not displayed on
is connected to a TV using a different video output connector, operate while watching the
the TV.
display on this unit.
•No status information is displayed for some 3D videos or videos with a computer resolution
such as VGA.
•When a 2D video is converted to a 3D video on the TV, the menu screen or status information
screen is not properly displayed.
•In the pure direct playback mode, the menu screen or status information is not displayed.
Switch to a sound mode other than the pure direct mode.
•Set the “TV Format” setting in the menu to a selection that is appropriate for the TV.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
235
Remote
Index
–
208
–
119, 120
178
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22iPod cannot be played back
Symptom
Cause/Solution
Page
•When using iPod by connecting it to the USB port, some iPod variations are not supported.
•When iPod is connected by using a USB cable other than the genuine cable, iPod may not be
recognized. Use a genuine USB cable.
50
–
•This unit and PC / iPhone / iPod touch / iPad are not connected to the same network (LAN).
The AirPlay icon ' is not displayed
Connect it to the same LAN as this unit.
on iTunes / iPhone / iPod touch / iPad.
•The firmware on iTunes / iPhone / iPod touch / iPad is not compatible with AirPlay. Update the
firmware to the latest version.
53
iPod cannot be connected.
Audio is not output.
•The volume on iTunes / iPhone / iPod touch / iPad is set to the minimum level. The volume on
iTunes / iPhone / iPod touch / iPad is linked with the volume on this unit. Set a proper volume
level.
•The AirPlay playback is not performed, or this unit is not selected. Click the AirPlay icon ' on
the iTunes / iPhone / iPod touch / iPad screen and select this unit.
–
–
107
Audio is interrupted during the AirPlay •Quit the application running in the background of the iPhone/iPod touch/iPad, and then play
playback on iPhone / iPod touch /
using AirPlay.
iPad.
•Some external factors may be affecting the wireless connection. Modify the network
environment by taking measures such as shortening the distance from the wireless LAN
access point.
–
iTunes cannot be played back through •Enable the “Allow iTunes audio control from remote speakers” setting on iTunes. Then, you
the remote control unit.
can perform playback, pause, and skip operations through the remote control unit.
–
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
236
Remote
Index
–
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22USB memory devices cannot be played back
Symptom
Cause/Solution
Page
•This unit may not recognize the USB memory device due to poor connection, etc. Make sure
that the connection is made properly by taking actions such as disconnecting and reconnecting
the USB memory device.
•USB memory devices of a mass storage class or those compatible with MTP are supported.
•This unit does not support a connection through a USB hub. Connect the USB memory device
directly to the USB port.
•The USB memory device must be formatted to FAT16 or FAT32.
•Not all USB memory devices are guaranteed to work. Some USB memory devices are not
recognized. When using a type of portable hard disc drive compatible with the USB connection
that requires power from an AC adapter, use the AC adapter that came with the drive.
49
•Files of a type not supported by this unit are not displayed.
•This unit can display a file structure with up to 8 levels and up to 5000 subfolders and files in
total. Modify the folder structure of the USB memory device.
•When multiple partitions exist on the USB memory device, only files on the first partition are
displayed.
67
–
Files on a USB memory device cannot •Files are created in a format that is not supported by this unit. Check the formats supported
be played.
by this unit.
•You are attempting to play a file that is copyright protected. Files that are copyright protected
cannot be played on this unit.
247
“No Connection” is displayed.
Files on the USB memory device are
not displayed.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
237
Remote
Index
–
–
–
–
–
–
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22File names on the iPod/USB memory device are not displayed properly
Symptom
The file names are not displayed
properly (“...”, etc.).
Cause/Solution
Page
•Characters that cannot be displayed are used. This is not a malfunction. On this unit, characters
that cannot be displayed are replaced with a “.” (period).
–
22The Internet radio cannot be played back
Symptom
Cause/Solution
Page
A list of broadcasting radio stations is
not displayed.
•The LAN cable is not properly connected, or the network is disconnected. Check the
connection status.
•Perform the network diagnostic mode.
53
Internet Radio cannot be played.
•The selected radio station is broadcasting in a format that is not supported by this unit.
Formats that can be played back in this unit are MP3, WMA and AAC.
•The firewall function is enabled on the router. Check the firewall setting.
•The IP address is not properly set.
•Check the power of the router is on.
•To obtain the IP address automatically, enable the DHCP server function on the router. Also,
set the DHCP setting to “On” on this unit.
•To obtain the IP address manually, set the IP address and proxy on this unit.
•Some radio stations broadcast silently during some time period. In this case, no audio is
output. Wait for a while and select the same radio station, or select another radio station.
249
Cannot connect to favorite radio
stations.
•Radio station is not currently in service. Register radio stations in service.
For some radio stations, “Connection •The selected radio station is not in service. Select a radio station in service.
down” is displayed and station cannot
be connected to.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
238
Remote
Index
–
–
200
–
200
200, 201
80
–
–
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22Music files on PC or NAS cannot be played back
Symptom
Cause/Solution
Page
Files stored on a computer cannot be
played.
•Files are stored in a non-compatible format. Record in a compatible format.
•You are attempting to play a file that is copyright protected. Files that are copyright protected
cannot be played on this unit.
•Set and computer are connected by USB cable. The set’s USB port cannot be used for
connection to a computer.
•Media sharing settings are not correct. Change media sharing settings so that the unit can
access the folders on your computer.
248
–
Server is not found, or it is not
possible to connect to the server.
•The computer’s or router’s firewall is activated. Check the computer’s or router’s firewall
settings.
•Computer’s power is not turned on. Turn on the power.
•Server is not running. Launch the server.
•Set’s IP address is wrong. Check the set’s IP address.
–
Music files on PC cannot be played
back.
•Even if PC is connected to the USB connector on this unit, music files on it cannot be played
back. Connect PC or NAS to this unit through the network.
53
Files on PC or NAS are not displayed.
•Files of a type not supported by this unit are not displayed.
248
Music stored on a NAS cannot be
played.
•If you use a NAS in conformity with the DLNA standard, enable the DLNA server function in
the NAS setting.
•If you use a NAS that does not conform with the DLNA standard, play the music via a PC.
Set Windows Media Player’s media sharing function and add NAS to the selected play folder.
•If connection is restricted, set audio equipment as the connection target.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
239
Remote
Index
–
84
–
–
199
–
84
–
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
22The HDMI control function does not work
Symptom
The HDMI control function does not
work.
Cause/Solution
Page
•Check that “HDMI Control” in the menu is set to “On”.
•You cannot operate devices that are not compatible with the HDMI control function. In
addition, depending on the connected device or the settings, the HDMI control function may
not work. In this case, operate the external device directly.
•Check that the HDMI control function setting is enabled on all devices connected to this unit.
•When you make connection related changes such as connecting an additional HDMI device,
the link operation settings may be initialized. Turn off this unit and devices connected via
HDMI, and turn them on again.
•The HDMI MONITOR 2 connector is not compatible with the HDMI control function. Use the
HDMI MONITOR 1 connector to connect to the TV.
174
132
132
132
40
22When using HDMI ZONE2, the devices does not function properly
Symptom
Cause/Solution
Page
When using MAIN ZONE, video
•With the same input source selected for MAIN ZONE and ZONE2, when you operate MAIN
output is interrupted in HDMI ZONE2.
ZONE, video may be interrupted in HDMI ZONE2.
When using HDMI ZONE2, no video
or audio is output from the TV in
ZONE2.
When using HDMI ZONE2, MAIN
ZONE audio is played back as PCM.
Front panel
Display
–
•Check that the power is on for ZONE2.
•Check the input source for ZONE2.
•The HDMI 7 (AUX 1) connector on the front panel does not support the HDMI ZONE2 function.
•In ZONE2, playback is only possible when the input signals are HDMI signals.
•When the TV does not support the input audio format, audio is not output. Set the audio
format to “PCM” on the playback device. Alternatively, set “ZONE2 Setup” – “HDMI Audio”
in the menu to “PCM”.
•When the TV is not compatible with the resolution of the input video, no video is output. Set
the output resolution on the playback device to a resolution that is compatible with the TV.
149
149
–
–
204
•When the same input source is selected for MAIN ZONE and ZONE2, the audio format is
limited according to the specifications of the TV in ZONE2.
–
Rear panel
240
Remote
Index
–
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Resetting factory settings
Perform this procedure if the display is abnormal or if operations cannot be performed.
Various settings are reset to the factory default values. Make settings again.
X
GAME
1
2
Turn off the power using X.
3
Once the display starts flashing at intervals of about 1
second, release the two buttons.
Press X while simultaneously pressing GAME and
A-DSX.
%
•If in step 3 the display does not flash at intervals of about 1 second, start over
from step 1.
A-DSX
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
241
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Appendix
About HDMI
•3D
This unit supports input and output of 3D (3 dimensional) video signals
of HDMI.
To play back 3D video, you need a TV and player that provide support for
the HDMI 3D function and a pair of 3D glasses.
•4K
This unit supports input and output of 4K Ultra HD (3840 x 2160 pixels)
video signals of HDMI.
•Content Type
It automatically makes settings suitable for the video output type
(content information).
•Adobe RGB color, Adobe YCC601 color
The color space defined by Adobe Systems Inc. Because it is a wider
color space than RGB, it can produce more vivid and natural images.
•sYCC601 color
Each of these color spaces defines a palette of available colors that is
larger than the traditional RGB color model.
•Auto Lip Sync
This function can automatically correct delay between the audio and
video.
Use a TV that is compatible with the Auto Lip Sync function.
•HDMI pass through
Even when the power to this unit is set to standby, signals input from
the HDMI input connector are output to a TV or other device that is
connected to the HDMI output connector.
HDMI is an abbreviation of High-Definition Multimedia Interface, which is
an AV digital interface that can be connected to a TV or amplifier.
With the HDMI connection, high definition video and high quality audio
formats adopted by Blu-ray disc players (Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby TrueHD,
DTS-HD, DTS-HD Master Audio) can be transmitted, which is not possible
with the analog video transmission.
Furthermore, in the HDMI connection, audio and video signals can
be transmitted through a single HDMI cable, while in conventional
connections it is necessary to provide audio and video cables separately
for connection between devices.
This allows you to simplify the wiring configuration that tends to be quite
complex in a home theater system.
This unit supports the following HDMI functions.
•Deep Color
An imaging technology supported by HDMI. Unlike RGB or YCbCr, which
uses 8 bits (256 shades) per color, it can use 10 bits (1024 shades), 12
bits (4096 shades), or 16 bits (65536 shades) to produce colors in higher
definition. Both devices linked via HDMI must support Deep Color.
•“x.v.Color”
This function lets HDTVs display colors more accurately. It enables
display with natural, vivid colors.
“x.v.Color” is trademark of Sony Corporation.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
242
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
•HDMI control
If you connect the unit and an HDMI control function compatible TV or
player with an HDMI cable and then enable the HDMI control function
setting on each device, the devices will be able to control each other.
•Power off link
This unit power off can be linked to the TV power off step.
•Audio output destination switching
From the TV, you can switch whether to output audio from the TV or
the AV amplifier.
•Volume adjustment
You can adjust this unit’s volume in the TV volume adjustment
operation.
•Input source switching
You can switch this unit input sources through linkage to TV input
switching.
When playing the player, this unit input source switches to the source
for that player.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Tips
Appendix
•ARC (Audio Return Channel)
This function transmits audio signals from the TV to this unit through the
HDMI cable and plays back the audio from the TV on this unit based on
the HDMI control function.
If a TV without the ARC function is connected via HDMI connections,
video signals of the playback device connected to this unit are
transmitted to the TV, but this unit can not play back the audio from the
TV. If you want to enjoy surround audio for TV program, a separate audio
cable connection is required. In contrast, if a TV with the ARC function is
connected via HDMI connections, no audio cable connection is required.
Audio signals from the TV can be input to this unit through the HDMI
cable between this unit and the TV. This function allows you to enjoy
surround playback on this unit for the TV.
243
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
22Supported audio formats
2-channel Linear PCM
Multi-channel Linear PCM
Bitstream
DSD
In order to play back digital video and audio such as BD-Video (Blu-ray
Disc) or DVD-Video via HDMI connection, both this unit and TV and the
player need to support the copyright protection system known as HDCP
(High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection System). HDCP is copyright
protection technology comprised of data encryption and authentication
of the connected AV devices. This unit supports HDCP.
•If a device that does not support HDCP is connected, video and audio
are not output correctly. Read the owner’s manual of your television or
player for more information.
%
•When connecting this unit to a device that is compatible with the Deep Color, 4K,
ARC function, use a “High Speed HDMI cable with Ethernet”.
22Supported video signals
•480p
•720p 60/50Hz
•4K 30/25/24Hz
Front panel
Display
Appendix
Copyright protection system
2-channel, 32 kHz – 192 kHz,
16/20/24 bit
7.1-channel, 32 kHz – 192 kHz,
16/20/24 bit
Dolby Digital / DTS / Dolby TrueHD /
Dolby Digital Plus /
DTS-HD Master Audio /
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio /
DTS Express
2-channel – 5.1-channel, 2.8224 MHz
•480i
•576p
•1080p 60/50/24Hz
Tips
•576i
•1080i 60/50Hz
Rear panel
244
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
Video conversion function
This unit automatically converts the input video signals as shown in the diagram below before outputting them to the TV.
This unit
Video device
Input
(IN)
Output
HDMI-compatible TV
Output
(MONITOR OUT)
Input
HDMI signal
HDMI connector
HDMI signal
HDMI connector
HDMI connector
HDMI connector
HDMI-incompatible
TV
Component video
signal
Component video
signal
Component video
connectors
Component video
connectors
Component video
connectors
Front panel
%
Video signal
Video signal
Video connector
Component video
connectors
Video connector
Display
Rear panel
Video connector
245
Video connector
Remote
Index
•The main zone video conversion
function is compatible with the
following formats: NTSC, PAL,
SECAM, NTSC4.43, PAL-N, PAL-M
and PAL-60.
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
This unit can convert the input video signals to the resolution that is set for “Resolution” (vpage 176) in the menu before outputting them to the TV.
Output signal
Input signal
480i/576i
HDMI
480i/576i
480p/576p
720p
1080i
1080p
1080p 24Hz
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
480p/576p
HDMI
720p
P
P
P
P
P
1080i
P
P
P
P
P
1080p 24Hz
P
P
P
1080p
P
P
P
P
P
P
4K 30/25/24Hz
480i/576i
P
P
480p/576p
Component Video
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
720p
P
P
P
P
P
1080i
P
P
1080p
Video
Front panel
4K 30/25/24Hz
480i/576i
P
Display
P
Rear panel
P
P
246
Remote
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Playing back USB memory devices
Tips
Appendix
•This unit is compatible with MP3 ID3-Tag (Ver. 2) standard.
•This unit can show the artwork that was embedded by using MP3 ID3Tag Ver. 2.3 or 2.4.
•This unit is compatible with WMA META tags.
•If the image size (pixels) of an album artwork exceeds 500 × 500 (WMA/
MP3/WAV/FLAC) or 349 × 349 (MPEG-4 AAC), then music may not be
played back properly.
z1 Copyright-protected files can be played on certain portable players compatible
with MTP.
z2 Only files that are not protected by copyright can be played on this unit.
Content downloaded from pay sites on the Internet are copyright protected.
Also, files encoded in WMA format when ripped from a CD, etc. on a computer
may be copyright protected, depending on the computer’s settings.
z3 Copyright [2012] [D&M Holdings. Inc.]
Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the “License”); you may not
use this file except in compliance with the License. You may obtain a copy of
the License at http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0.
22Compatible formats
22Maximum Number of Playable Files and Folder
WMA
(Windows
Media Audio)z1
MP3
(MPEG-1 Audio
Layer-3)
WAV
MPEG-4 AACz2
FLAC
(Free Lossless
Audio Codec)
ALAC
(Apple Lossless
Audio Codec)z3
Front panel
Sampling frequency
Bit rate
Extension
32/44.1/48 kHz
48 – 192 kbps
.wma
32/44.1/48 kHz
32 – 320 kbps
The limits on the number of folders and files that can be displayed by
this unit are as follows.
Media
Item
Memory capacity
Number of folder directory levels
.mp3
z1
32/44.1/48/88.2/96/
176.4/192 kHz
–
.wav
32/44.1/48 kHz
16 – 320 kbps
.aac/
.m4a/
.mp4
32/44.1/48/88.2/96/
176.4/192 kHz
–
.flac
32/44.1/48/88.2/96 kHz
–
.m4a
Display
Rear panel
Number of folders
Number of filesz2
USB memory devices
FAT16 : 2 GB, FAT32 : 2 TB
8 levels
500
5000
z1 The limited number includes the root folder.
z2 The allowable number of files may differ according to the USB memory device
capacity and the file size.
247
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Playing back files stored on PC or
NAS
Appendix
Tips
22Specifications of supported files
•This unit is compatible with MP3 ID3-Tag (Ver. 2) standard.
•This unit can show the artwork that was embedded by using MP3 ID3Tag Ver. 2.3 or 2.4.
•This unit is compatible with WMA META tags.
•If the image size (pixels) of an album artwork exceeds 500 × 500 (WMA/
MP3/WAV/FLAC) or 349 × 349 (MPEG-4 AAC), then music may not be
played back properly.
•A server or server software compatible with distribution in the
corresponding formats is required to play music files via a network.
Sampling frequency
Bit rate
Extension
WMA
(Windows
Media Audio)
32/44.1/48 kHz
48 – 192 kbps
.wma
MP3
(MPEG-1 Audio
Layer-3)
32/44.1/48 kHz
32 – 320 kbps
.mp3
32/44.1/48/88.2/96/
176.4/192 kHz
–
.wav
32/44.1/48 kHz
16 – 320 kbps
.aac/
.m4a/
.mp4
32/44.1/48/88.2/96/
176.4/192 kHz
–
.flac
–
.m4a
WAV
MPEG-4
AACz1
FLAC
(Free Lossless
Audio Codec)
ALAC
(Apple Lossless 32/44.1/48/88.2/96 kHz
Audio Codec)z2
z1 Only files that are not protected by copyright can be played on this unit.
Content downloaded from pay sites on the Internet are copyright protected.
Also, files encoded in WMA format when ripped from a CD, etc. on a computer
may be copyright protected, depending on the computer’s settings.
z2 Copyright [2012] [D&M Holdings. Inc.]
Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the “License”); you may not
use this file except in compliance with the License. You may obtain a copy of
the License at http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
248
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Playing back Internet Radio
Personal memory plus function
22Playable broadcast station specifications
This function sets the settings (input mode, sound mode, HDMI output
mode, MultEQ® XT32, Dynamic EQ, audio delay etc.) last selected for the
individual input sources.
WMA
(Windows
Media Audio)
MP3
(MPEG-1 Audio
Layer-3)
MPEG-4 AAC
Front panel
Sampling frequency
Bit rate
Extension
32/44.1/48 kHz
48 – 192 kbps
.wma
32/44.1/48 kHz
32 – 320 kbps
.mp3
32/44.1/48 kHz
16 – 320 kbps
.aac/
.m4a/
.mp4
Display
Rear panel
%
•The surround parameters, tone control settings are stored for the individual sound
modes.
Last function memory
This function stores the settings which were made before going into the
standby mode.
249
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
Sound modes and channel output
S This indicates the audio output channels or surround parameters that can be set.
D This indicates the audio output channels. The output channels depend on the settings of “Speaker Config.” (vpage 193).
Channel output
Sound mode (vpage 118)
Front L/R
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
DIRECT/PURE DIRECT (2-channel)
DIRECT/PURE DIRECT (Multi-channel)
DSD DIRECT (2-channel)
DSD DIRECT (Multi-channel)
STEREO
MULTI CH IN
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gz
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx
DOLBY PRO LOGIC g
DOLBY PRO LOGIC g A-DSX
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx A-DSX
DTS NEO:X
Audyssey DSX®
DOLBY DIGITAL
DOLBY DIGITAL Plus
DOLBY TrueHD
DTS SURROUND
DTS 96/24
DTS-HD
DTS Express
MULTI CH STEREO
VIRTUAL
z1
z2
z3 z4
Center
Surround L/R
Surround back L/R
Front height L/R
Front wide L/R
D
D
Dz1
Dz1
Dz1
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
Dz1
D
D
Dz2
D
D
D
D
D
Dz1
Dz1
D
D
Dz1
D
D
Dz3
Dz3
D
Dz3
Dz2
Dz1
Dz1
Dz2
Dz2
Dz1
Dz2
D
Dz3
Dz3
D
Dz3
Dz1
Dz1
Dz1
D
A signal for each channel contained in an input signal is output as audio.
Audio is output when the set sound mode name contains “+PLgz”.
Audio is output from the speakers specified in the “Audyssey DSX®” (vpage 170) settings.
Audio is output when “Subwoofer Mode” (vpage 198) in the menu is set to “LFE+Main”.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
250
Remote
Index
Subwoofer
Dz4
D
Dz4
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
D
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
Sound modes and surround parameters
Surround Parameter (vpage 162)
Sound mode (vpage 118)
Dialog Level
(vpage 161)
Subwoofer Level
(vpage 161)
DIRECT/PURE DIRECT (2-channel)z5
DIRECT/PURE DIRECT (Multi-channel)z5
DSD DIRECT (2-channel)z5
DSD DIRECT (Multi-channel)z5
STEREO
MULTI CH IN
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gz
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx
DOLBY PRO LOGIC g
DOLBY PRO LOGIC g A-DSX
S
S
S
S
S
Sz6
S
Sz6
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx A-DSX
DTS NEO:X
Audyssey DSX®
DOLBY DIGITAL
DOLBY DIGITAL Plus
DOLBY TrueHD
DTS SURROUND
DTS 96/24
DTS-HD
DTS Express
MULTI CH STEREO
VIRTUAL
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Home Theater
EQ
(vpage 162)
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Loudness
Management
z1
(vpage 162)
S
S
Dynamic
Compression
z2
(vpage 162)
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Low Frequency
Effects
z3
(vpage 163)
Display
Rear panel
251
Remote
Speaker Select
(vpage 164)
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
z1 – z7 : vpage 253
Front panel
Height Gain
z4
(vpage 164)
Index
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Sz7
Sz7
Sz7
Sz7
Sz7
Sz7
Sz7
S
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
Surround Parameter (vpage 162)
PRO LOGIC g/gx Music mode only
Sound mode (vpage 118)
NEO:X
mode only
Center
Panorama
Dimension
Center Gain
Width
(vpage 163) (vpage 163)
(vpage 163)
(vpage 164)
DIRECT/PURE DIRECT (2-channel)z5
DIRECT/PURE DIRECT (Multi-channel)z5
DSD DIRECT (2-channel)z5
DSD DIRECT (Multi-channel)z5
STEREO
MULTI CH IN
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gz
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx
DOLBY PRO LOGIC g
DOLBY PRO LOGIC g A-DSX
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx A-DSX
DTS NEO:X
Audyssey DSX®
DOLBY DIGITAL
DOLBY DIGITAL Plus
DOLBY TrueHD
DTS SURROUND
DTS 96/24
DTS-HD
DTS Express
MULTI CH STEREO
VIRTUAL
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Audyssey (vpage 167)
Tone
z8
(vpage 165)
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
M-DAX
z11
MultEQ®
Dynamic
Dynamic
Audyssey
Audyssey (vpage 165)
XT32
EQ
Volume
LFC™
DSX®
z9
z10
z10
(vpage 169) (vpage 170)
(vpage 167) (vpage 168) (vpage 169)
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
z5, z8 – z11 : vpage 253
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
252
Remote
Index
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
z1 This item can be selected when a Dolby TrueHD signal is played.
z2 This item can be selected when a Dolby Digital or DTS signal is played.
z3 This item can be selected when a Dolby Digital or DTS signal or DVD-Audio is played.
z4 This setting is available when the set sound mode name contains “+PLgz”.
z5 During playback in PURE DIRECT mode, the surround parameters are the same as in DIRECT mode.
z6 This setting is available when “Subwoofer Mode” (vpage 198) in the menu is set to “LFE+Main”.
z7 This setting is available when the set sound mode name contains “+Neo:X”.
z8 This item cannot be set when “Dynamic EQ” (vpage 168) is set to “On”.
z9 This item cannot be set when Audyssey® Setup (Speaker Calibration) has not been performed.
z10 This item cannot be set when “MultEQ® XT32” (vpage 167) is set to “Off” or “Graphic EQ”.
z11 This item can be set when the input signal is analog, PCM 48 kHz or 44.1 kHz.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
253
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
Types of input signals, and corresponding sound modes
F This indicates the default sound mode.
S This indicates the selectable sound mode.
2-channel signal
Sound mode (vpage 118)
NOTE
Analog /
PCM
Dolby
Digital
(+/HD) /
DTS
(-HD)
Multi-channel signal
DSD
(Super
Audio
CD)
PCM
Multi
DTS-HD
DTS
Express
DTS ES
DSCRT
6.1
DTS ES
MTRIX
6.1
DTS
DOLBY
TrueHD
DOLBY DOLBY
DOLBY
DIGITAL DIGITAL
DIGITAL
Plus
EX
DTS SURROUND
DTS-HD MSTR
DTS-HD HI RES
Fz7
Fz8
DTS ES DSCRT6.1
z1
DTS ES MTRX6.1
DTS SURROUND
DTS 96/24
DTS (–HD) + PLgx
DTS (–HD) + PLgz
DTS Express
DTS (–HD) + NEO:X
DTS NEO:X
z1
F
z1z2
z3
z4
z5
S
S
S
S
S
S
F
S
S
F
S
S
S
F
Fz9
S
S
S
S
S
S
DOLBY SURROUND
DOLBY TrueHD
DOLBY DIGITAL+
DOLBY DIGITAL EX
DOLBY (D+) (HD) +EX
DOLBY DIGITAL
DOLBY (D) (D+) (HD) + PLgx
DOLBY (D) (D+) (HD) + PLgz
DOLBY (D) (D+) (HD) +
NEO:X
DOLBY PRO LOGIC g/gx
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gz
F
F
z1
z1
S
S
z1z2
z3
S
S
S
z4
z6
z3
S
S
S
S
S
S
z1 – z9 : vpage 256
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
254
Remote
Index
S
S
S
S
F
S
S
F
S
S
S
S
S
DSD
(Super
Audio
CD)
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
2-channel signal
Sound mode (vpage 118)
NOTE
Analog /
PCM
Dolby
Digital
(+/HD) /
DTS
(-HD)
Appendix
Tips
Multi-channel signal
DSD
(Super
Audio
CD)
PCM
Multi
DTS-HD
DTS
Express
DTS ES
DSCRT
6.1
DTS ES
MTRIX
6.1
DTS
DOLBY
TrueHD
DOLBY DOLBY
DOLBY
DIGITAL DIGITAL
DIGITAL
Plus
EX
DSD
(Super
Audio
CD)
MULTI CH IN
MULTI CH IN
MULTI CH IN + DOLBY EX
MULTI CH IN + PLgx
MULTI CH IN + PLgz
MULTI CH IN + NEO:X
MULTI CH IN 7.1
Audyssey
Audyssey DSX®
DOLBY PLg/gx A-DSX
DIRECT
DIRECT
PURE DIRECT
PURE DIRECT
DSP SIMULATION
MULTI CH STEREO
VIRTUAL
STEREO
STEREO
z1
F
S
F
S
z1z2
S
S
z3
z4
z1
S
S
Fz10
S
z6
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
F
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
S
Sz11
S
S
z1 – z4, z6, z10, z11 : vpage 256
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
255
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
z1 This item can be selected when surround back speakers are used.
z2 The Cinema mode or Music mode can be selected. When using a single surround back speaker, the Music mode is used.
z3 This item can be selected when front height speakers are used.
z4 The Cinema mode, Music mode or Game mode can be selected. This item can be selected when using any of the Surround back, Front height or Front wide speaker.
z5 The Cinema mode, Music mode or Game mode can be selected.
z6 The Movie mode, Music mode or Game mode can be selected.
z7 This item can be selected when the input signal is DTS-HD MASTER AUDIO.
z8 This item can be selected when the input signal is DTS-HD HI RESOLUTION.
z9 This item can be selected when the input signal is DTS 96/24.
z10 The default sound mode for the AirPlay playback is DIRECT.
z11 This item can be selected when the input signals contain surround back signals.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
256
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Explanation of terms
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Audyssey Dynamic Surround Expansion
(A-DSX)
Audyssey DSX® is a scalable system that adds new speakers to improve
surround sound vividness.
Starting with a 5.1 system Audyssey DSX® first adds Wide channels for
the biggest impact on envelopment. Research in human hearing has
proven that information from the Wide channels is much more critical
in the presentation of a realistic soundstage than the Back Surround
channels found in traditional 7.1 systems. Audyssey DSX® then creates a
pair of Height channels to reproduce the next most important acoustical
and perceptual cues. In addition to these new Wide and Height channels,
Audyssey DSX® applies Surround Envelopment Processing to enhance the
blend between the front and surround channels.
Audyssey Dynamic Volume®
Dynamic Volume solves the problem of large variations in volume level
between television programs, commercials, and between the soft and
loud passages of movies. Audyssey Dynamic EQ® is integrated into
Dynamic Volume so that as the playback volume is adjusted automatically,
the perceived bass response, tonal balance, surround impression, and
dialog clarity remain the same.
Audyssey MultEQ® XT32
MultEQ® XT32 is a room equalization solution that calibrates any audio
system so that it can achieve optimum performance for every listener in
a large listening area. Based on several room measurements, MultEQ®
XT32 calculates an equalization solution that corrects for both time and
frequency response problems in the listening area and also performs a
fully automated surround system setup.
A
A2DP
A2DP is one profile of Bluetooth defined for in-car devices or AV devices
that use wireless communication instead of a cable.
AirPlay
AirPlay sends (plays) contents recorded in iTunes or on an iPhone/iPod
touch/iPad to a compatible device via the network.
ALAC (Apple Lossless Audio Codec)
This is a codec for lossless audio compression method developed by
Apple Inc. This codec can be played back on iTunes, iPod or iPhone. Data
compressed to approximately 60 – 70 % can be decompressed to exactly
the same original data.
App Store
App Store is a site that sells application software for such devices as the
iPhone or iPod Touch, and is operated by Apple Inc.
Audyssey Dynamic EQ®
Dynamic EQ solves the problem of deteriorating sound quality as volume
is decreased by taking into account human perception and room acoustics.
Audyssey Dynamic EQ® works in tandem with Audyssey MultEQ® XT32 to
provide well-balanced sound for every listener at any volume level.
Front panel
Tips
257
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
D
DLNA
DLNA and DLNA CERTIFIED are trademarks and/or service marks of
Digital Living Network Alliance.
Some contents may not be compatible with other DLNA CERTIFIED®
products.
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital is a multi-channel digital signal format developed by Dolby
Laboratories.
A total of 5.1-channels are played: 3 front channels (“FL”, “FR” and “C”),
2 surround channels (“SL” and “SR”) and the “LFE” channel for low
frequency effects.
Because of this, there is no crosstalk between channels and a realistic
sound field with a “three-dimensional” feeling (sense of distance,
movement and positioning) is achieved. This delivers a thrilling surround
sound experience in the home.
Dolby Digital EX
Dolby Digital EX is a 6.1-channel surround format from Dolby Laboratories
that allows users to enjoy in their homes the “DOLBY DIGITAL SURROUND
EX” audio format jointly developed by Dolby Laboratories and Lucasfilm.
The 6.1-channels of sound, including surround back channel, provide
improved sound positioning and expansion of the surround sound field.
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Digital Plus is an improved Dolby Digital signal format that is
compatible with up to 7.1-channels of discrete digital sound and also
improves sound quality thanks to extra data bit rate performance. It is
upwardly compatible with conventional Dolby Digital, so it offers greater
flexibility in response to the source signal and the conditions of the
playback device.
Dolby Pro Logic g
Dolby Pro Logic g is a matrix decoding technology developed by Dolby
Laboratories.
Regular music such as that on CDs is encoded into 5-channels to achieve
an excellent surround effect.
The surround channel signals are converted into stereo and full band
signals (with a frequency response of 20 Hz to 20 kHz or greater) to create
a “three-dimensional” sound image offering a rich sense of presence for
all stereo sources.
Dolby Pro Logic gx
Dolby Pro Logic gx is a further improved version of the Dolby Pro Logic g
matrix decoding technology.
Audio signals recorded in 2-channels are decoded to achieve a natural
sound with up to 7.1-channels.
There are three modes: “Music” suited for playing music, “Movie” suited
for playing movies, and “Game” which is optimized for playing games.
B
Bluetooth
Bluetooth is a short-distance wireless communication technology used for
connecting handheld devices several meters apart. This enables notebook
computers, PDA s, mobile phones, etc. to connect without a cable for
transmitting audio and data.
Front panel
Tips
258
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD is a high definition audio technology developed by Dolby
Laboratories, using lossless coding technology to faithfully reproduce the
sound of the studio master.
This format provides the facility to support up to 8 audio channels with a
sampling frequency of 96 kHz/24 bit resolution and up to 6 audio channels
with a sampling frequency of 192 kHz/24 bit resolution. Dolby TrueHD is
adopted for applications that put very high importance on sound quality.
Downmix
This function converts the number of channels of surround audio to
a lower number of channels and plays back according to the system’s
configuration.
DTS
This is an abbreviation of Digital Theater System, which is a digital audio
system developed by DTS.
DTS delivers a powerful and dynamic surround sound experience, and is
found in the world’s finest movie theaters and screening rooms.
DTS 96/24
DTS 96/24 is a digital audio format enabling high sound quality playback in
5.1-channels with a sampling frequency of 96 kHz and 24 bit quantization
on DVD-Video.
Dolby Pro Logic gz
Dolby Pro Logic gz introduces a new dimension to Home Entertainment
through the addition of a pair of front height channels. Compatible with
stereo, 5.1-channel and 7.1-channel content, Dolby Pro Logic gz provides
enhanced spaciousness, depth and dimension to movies, concert video
and video game playback while maintaining the full integrity of the source
mix.
Dolby Pro Logic gz identifies and decodes spatial cues that occur naturally
in all content, directing this information to the front height channels,
complementing the performance of left and right surround sound
speakers. Content that is encoded with Dolby Pro Logic gz height channel
information can be even more revealing, with perceptually discrete
height channel information bringing an exciting new dimension to home
entertainment.
Dolby Pro Logic gz, with front height channels is also an ideal alternative
for households that cannot support the placement of back surround
speakers of a typical 7.1-channel system but may have bookshelf space
available to support the addition of height speakers.
Front panel
Tips
259
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
DTS Digital Surround
DTS Digital Surround is the standard digital surround format of DTS,
Inc., compatible with a sampling frequency of 44.1 or 48 kHz and up to
5.1-channels of digital discrete surround sound.
DTS-ES™ Discrete 6.1
DTS-ES™ Discrete 6.1 is a 6.1-channel discrete digital audio format adding
a surround back (SB) channel to the DTS digital surround sound.
Decoding of conventional 5.1-channel audio signals is also possible
according to the decoder.
DTS-ES™ Matrix 6.1
DTS-ES™ Matrix 6.1 is a 6.1-channel audio format that inserts a surround
back (SB) channel to the DTS digital surround sound through matrix
encoding. Decoding of conventional 5.1-channel audio signals is also
possible according to the decoder.
DTS Express
DTS Express is an audio format supporting low bit rates (max. 5.1-channels,
24 to 256 kbps).
DTS-HD
This audio technology provides higher sound quality and enhanced
functionality than the conventional DTS and is adopted as an optional audio
for Blu-ray Disc. This technology supports multi-channel, high data transfer
speed, high sampling frequency, and lossless audio playback. Maximum
7.1-channels are supported in Blu-ray Disc.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Tips
Appendix
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is an improved version of the conventional
DTS, DTS-ES and DTS 96/24 signals formats, compatible with sampling
frequencies of 96 or 48 kHz and up to 7.1-channels of discrete digital sound.
High data bit rate performance provides high quality sound. This format is
fully compatible with conventional products, including conventional DTS
digital surround 5.1-channel data.
DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS-HD Master Audio is a lossless audio format created by Digital
Theater System (DTS). This format provides the facility to support
up to 8 audio channels with a sampling frequency of 96 kHz/
24 bit resolution and up to 6 audio channels with a sampling frequency of
192 kHz/24 bit resolution. It is fully compatible with conventional products,
including conventional DTS digital surround 5.1-channel data.
DTS Neo:X
This matrix decoding technology uses the DTS NEO:X decoder to playback
2-channel source or 5.1/6.1/7.1-channel surround sources as a maximum
of 9.1-channel surround sound. There are 3 modes: “Music” suited for
playing music, “Cinema” suited for playing movies, and “Game” which is
optimized for playing games.
Dynamic range
The difference between the maximum undistorted sound level and the
minimum discernible level above the noise emitted by the device.
260
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
FLAC
FLAC stands for Free lossless Audio Codec, and is a lossless free audio
file format. Lossless means that the audio is compressed without any loss
in quality.
The FLAC license is as shown below.
Copyright (C) 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008,
2009 Josh Coalson
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
•Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
•Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice,
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation
and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
•Neither the name of the Xiph.org Foundation nor the names of its
contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from
this software without specific prior written permission.
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND
CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY,
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,
OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE
USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
F
Front panel
Tips
H
HDCP
When transmitting digital signals between devices, this copyright
protection technology encrypts the signals to prevent content from being
copied without authorization.
I
iTunes
iTunes is the name of the multimedia player provided by Apple Inc. It
enables management and playback of multimedia contents including
music and movies. iTunes supports many main file formats including AAC,
WAV, and MP3.
261
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
L
LFE
This is an abbreviation of Low Frequency Effect, which is an output channel
that emphasizes low frequency effect sound. Surround audio is intensified
by outputting 20 Hz to 120 Hz deep bass to the system subwoofer(s).
Display
Rear panel
Appendix
P
Pairing
Pairing is an operation required for settings to connect two Bluetooth
devices. Pairing enables Bluetooth devices to access each other.
Progressive (sequential scanning)
This is a scanning system of the video signal that displays 1 frame of video
as one image. Compared to the interlace system, this system provides
images with less flickering and jagged edges.
Protection circuit
This is a function to prevent damage to devices within the power supply
when an abnormality such as an overload, excess voltage occurs or over
temperature for any reason.
If a malfunction occurs in this unit, the power indicator blinks red and the
unit switches to standby mode.
M
MAIN ZONE
The room where this unit is placed is called the MAIN ZONE.
Modem
Device that connects to your broadband internet provider, and is very
often supplied with the service.
A type that is integrated with a router is also often available.
MP3 (MPEG Audio Layer-3)
This is an internationally standardized audio data compression scheme,
using the “MPEG-1” video compression standard. It compresses the data
volume to about one eleventh its original size while maintaining sound
quality equivalent to a music CD.
MPEG (Moving Picture Experts Group),
MPEG-2, MPEG-4
These are the names for digital compression format standards used for the
encoding of video and audio. Video standards include “MPEG-1 Video”,
“MPEG-2 Video”, “MPEG-4 Visual”, “MPEG-4 AVC”. Audio standards
include “MPEG-1 Audio”, “MPEG-2 Audio”, “MPEG-4 AAC”.
Front panel
Tips
S
Sampling frequency
Sampling involves taking a reading of a sound wave (analog signal) at
regular intervals and expressing the height of the wave at each reading in
digitized format (producing a digital signal).
The number of readings taken in one second is called the “sampling
frequency”. The larger the value, the closer the reproduced sound is to
the original.
Speaker impedance
This is an AC resistance value, indicated in Ω (Ohms). Greater power can
be obtained when this value is smaller.
262
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
V
vTuner
This is a free online content server for Internet Radio. Note that usage fees
are included in upgrade costs.
For inquiries about this service, visit the vTuner site below.
vTuner website: http://www.radiomarantz.com
This product is protected by certain intellectual property rights of
Nothing Else Matters Software and BridgeCo. Use or distribution of such
technology outside of this product is prohibited without a license from
Nothing Else Matters Software and BridgeCo or an authorized subsidiary.
Windows Media Player Ver.11 or later
This is a media player distributed free of charge by Microsoft Corporation.
It can play playlists created with Ver.11 or later of Windows Media Player,
as well as WMA, DRM WMA, WAV, and other files.
WMA (Windows Media Audio)
This is audio compression technology developed by Microsoft Corporation.
WMA data can be encoded using Windows Media® Player.
To encode WMA files, only use applications authorized by Microsoft
Corporation. If you use an unauthorized application, the file may not work
properly.
W
Windows Media DRM
This is a copyright protection technology developed by Microsoft.
Content providers are using the digital rights management technology
for Windows Media contained in this device (WM-DRM) to protect
the integrity of their content (Secure Content) so that their intellectual
property, including copyright, in such content is not misappropriated.
This device uses WM-DRM software to play Secure Content (WM-DRM
Software). If the security of the WM-DRM Software in this device has been
compromised, owners of Secure Content (Secure Content Owners) may
request that Microsoft revoke the WM-DRM Software’s right to acquire
new licenses to copy, display and/or play Secure Content. Revocation does
not alter the WM-DRM Software’s ability to play unprotected content. A
list of revoked WM-DRM Software is sent to your device whenever you
download a license for Secure Content from the Internet or from a PC.
Microsoft may, in conjunction with such license, also download revocation
list onto your device on behalf of Secure Content Owners.
Z
ZONE2
This unit can operate in a room other than the room where this unit is
placed (MAIN ZONE) (ZONE2 playback). The room for ZONE2 playback is
called ZONE2.
ZONE3
This unit can operate in a room other than the room where this unit is
placed (MAIN ZONE) (ZONE3 playback). The room for ZONE3 playback is
called ZONE3.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
263
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
Trademark information
Manufactured under a license from U.S. Patent No’s: 5,956,674;
5,974,380; 5,978,762; 6,487,535; 6,226,616; 7,212,872; 7,272,567;
7,668,723; 7,392,195; 7,930,184; 7,333,929; 7,548,853; 7,003,467 and
7,283,634. DTS, the Symbol, and DTS and the Symbol together are
registered trademarks & DTS Neo:X | 9.1 is a trademark of DTS, Inc.
©2012 DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved.
Manufactured under license from Audyssey Laboratories™. U.S. and
foreign patents pending. Audyssey MultEQ® XT32, Audyssey Dynamic
EQ®, Audyssey Dynamic Volume®, Audyssey DSX® and Audyssey LFC™
are registered trademarks of Audyssey Laboratories.
The terms HDMI and HDMI High-Definition Multimedia Interface, and
the HDMI Logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI
Licensing LLC in the United States and other countries.
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. “Dolby”, “Pro
Logic” and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
InstaPrevue and the InstaPrevue logo are trademarks or registered
trademarks of Silicon Image, Inc. in the United States and other countries.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
264
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
“Made for iPod” and “Made for iPhone” mean that an electronic
accessory has been designed to connect specifically to iPod, or iPhone,
respectively, and has been certified by the developer to meet Apple
performance standards.
Apple is not responsible for the operation of this device or its compliance
with safety and regulatory standards. Please note that the use of this
accessory with iPod, or iPhone, may affect wireless performance.
AirPlay, the AirPlay logo, iPad, iPhone, iPod, iPod classic, iPod nano, iPod
shuffle and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the
U.S. and other countries.
•Individual users are permitted to use iPhone, iPod, iPod classic, iPod
nano, iPod shuffle, and iPod touch for private copy and playback of
non-copyrighted contents and contents whose copy and playback is
permitted by law. Copyright infringement is prohibited by law.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
Tips
Appendix
Windows Media and the Windows logo are trademarks or registered
trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and/or other
countries.
Adobe, the Adobe logo and Reader are either registered trademarks or
trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United States and/or
other countries.
265
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Specifications
22Audio section
•Power amplifier
Rated output:
Output connectors:
•Analog
Input sensitivity/Input impedance:
Frequency response:
S/N:
Distortion:
Rated output:
Front panel
Display
Front:
125 W + 125 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz – 20 kHz with 0.08 % T.H.D.)
165 W + 165 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
Center:
125 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz – 20 kHz with 0.08 % T.H.D.)
165 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
Surround:
125 W + 125 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz – 20 kHz with 0.08 % T.H.D.)
165 W + 165 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
Surround back / Front height / Front wide:
125 W + 125 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz – 20 kHz with 0.08 % T.H.D.)
165 W + 165 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
6 – 8 Ω/ohms
200 mV/47 kΩ/kohms
10 Hz – 100 kHz — +1, –3 dB (DIRECT mode)
100 dB (IHF–A weighted, DIRECT mode)
0.005 % (20 Hz – 20 kHz) (DIRECT mode)
1.2 V
Rear panel
266
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
•Digital
D/A output:
Rated output — 2 V (at 0 dB playback)
Total harmonic distortion — 0.008 % (1 kHz, at 0 dB)
S/N ratio — 102 dB
Dynamic range — 100 dB
Digital input:
Format — Digital audio interface
•Phono equalizer (PHONO input — MEDIA PLAYER OUT)
Input sensitivity:
2.5 mV
RIAA deviation:
±1 dB (20 Hz to 20 kHz)
S/N:
74 dB (A weighting, with 5 mV input)
Rated output:
150 mV
Distortion factor:
0.03 % (1 kHz, 3 V)
22Video section
•Standard video connectors
Input/output level and impedance:
Frequency response:
•Color component video connector
Input/output level and impedance:
Frequency response:
Front panel
Display
1 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
5 Hz – 10 MHz — 0, –3 dB
Y signal — 1 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
PB / CB signal — 0.7 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
PR / CR signal — 0.7 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
5 Hz – 60 MHz — 0, –3 dB
Rear panel
267
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
22Tuner section
(ANTENNA input – MEDIA PLAYER OUT)
Settings
[FM]
(Note: μV at 75 Ω/ohms, 0 dBf = 1 x 10–15 W)
87.5 MHz – 107.9 MHz
1.5 μV (14.8 dBf)
MONO 78 dB
STEREO 68 dB
HD
85 dB
MONO 0.1 %
STEREO 0.2 %
HD
0.02 %
Receiving Range:
Usable Sensitivity:
S/N (IHF–A weighted):
Distortion (1 kHz):
Tips
[AM]
530 kHz – 1710 kHz
20 μV
85 dB
0.02 %
22General
Power supply:
Power consumption:
Power consumption in standby mode:
Power consumption in CEC standby mode:
Power consumption in network standby mode:
AC 120 V, 60 Hz
710 W
0.2 W
0.5 W
2.7 W
For purposes of improvement, specifications and design are subject to change without notice.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
268
Remote
Appendix
Index
Contents
Connections
Index
Settings
vv C
vv Numerics
3D········································································· 242
4K·········································································· 242
vv A
A2DP······························································· 55, 257
Accessories······························································· 7
Add New Feature·················································· 210
Adjusting the master volume·································· 61
AirPlay··························································· 107, 257
ALAC····································································· 257
AM loop antenna····················································· 51
App Store······························································ 257
Audio settings······················································· 161
Audyssey Dynamic EQ®········································ 257
Audyssey Dynamic Surround Expansion·············· 257
Audyssey Dynamic Volume®································· 257
Audyssey MultEQ® XT32······································ 257
Audyssey settings········································· 167, 185
Audyssey® Setup··················································· 183
Auto Standby························································ 206
vv B
Bi-amp····································································· 37
Bluetooth························································ 55, 258
Front panel
Playback
Display
Appendix
vv D
Cables····································································· 28
Connection
7.1CH IN······························································· 48
DC OUT································································ 57
DVD player··························································· 45
FM/AM································································· 51
Home network (LAN)··········································· 53
iPod (USB)···························································· 49
Power amplifier···················································· 38
Power cord··························································· 58
REMOTE CONTROL············································ 56
Set-top box··························································· 44
Speaker································································ 32
Turntable······························································ 47
TV····························································· 40, 41, 42
USB memory device············································ 49
Video camcorder·················································· 46
Wireless receiver················································· 55
Content Type························································ 242
Convenient function menu
All Zone Stereo··················································· 117
Picture Mode······················································ 116
Random······························································ 111
Remove from Favorites······································ 113
Repeat································································ 111
Save to Favorites················································ 112
Slideshow··························································· 114
Slideshow Interval·············································· 115
Text Search························································ 113
Video Select······················································· 115
Rear panel
Tips
269
Remote
Deep Color···························································· 242
DLNA···································································· 258
Dolby
Dolby Digital··············································· 122, 258
Dolby Digital EX·········································· 122, 258
Dolby Digital Plus······································· 122, 258
Dolby Pro Logic II······································· 122, 258
Dolby Pro Logic IIx····································· 122, 258
Dolby Pro Logic IIz····································· 122, 259
Dolby TrueHD············································· 122, 259
Downmix······························································· 259
DTS······································································· 259
DTS 96/24·················································· 123, 259
DTS Digital Surround·········································· 260
DTS-ES Discrete 6.1··································· 123, 260
DTS-ES Matrix 6.1······································ 123, 260
DTS Express··············································· 123, 260
DTS-HD······················································ 123, 260
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio·························· 260
DTS-HD Master Audio········································ 260
DTS Neo:X·················································· 123, 260
Dual backup memory function······························ 140
Dynamic range······················································ 260
vv E
Error messages (Audyssey® Setup)······················ 190
Index
Contents
Connections
vv F
Settings
vv L
Firmware update··················································· 209
FLAC····································································· 261
Flickr········································································ 87
FM indoor antenna·················································· 51
Front height speaker········································· 31, 35
Front panel······························································ 12
Front wide speaker··········································· 31, 35
vv H
HDCP···························································· 244, 261
HDMI control················································ 132, 174
HD Radio································································· 70
Headphones···························································· 14
vv I
Information···························································· 207
Audio·································································· 207
Firmware···························································· 207
Notifications······················································· 208
Video·································································· 207
ZONE·································································· 207
Input signal···························································· 254
Inputting characters·············································· 159
InstaPrevue··························································· 133
iPod Browse Mode················································· 64
iTunes··································································· 261
Front panel
Playback
Display
Appendix
vv P
LFE········································································ 262
Listening position·················································· 184
vv M
Main Display··························································· 17
MAIN ZONE·························································· 262
Menu map····························································· 151
Audio·························································· 151, 161
General······················································· 156, 203
Inputs························································· 154, 179
Network····················································· 155, 199
Setup Assistant·················································· 157
Speakers···················································· 155, 183
Video·························································· 153, 172
Modem································································· 262
MP3······································································ 262
MPEG···································································· 262
vv N
Network settings·················································· 199
Rear panel
Tips
270
Remote
Pairing··································································· 262
Pandora®·································································· 92
Panel lock function················································ 141
Playback
ALAC······························································ 67, 83
Blu-ray Disc player················································ 61
DVD player··························································· 61
FLAC······························································ 67, 83
Flickr····································································· 87
HD Radio······························································ 71
Internet Radio······················································· 79
iPod (USB)···························································· 62
JPEG······························································ 67, 83
MP3·························································· 67, 79, 83
MPEG-4 AAC············································ 67, 79, 83
NAS······································································ 83
Pandora®······························································· 92
PC········································································· 83
SiriusXM······························································· 98
Spotify································································ 101
USB memory device············································ 67
WAV······························································· 67, 83
WMA························································ 67, 79, 83
ZONE2/ZONE3··················································· 149
Preset codes················································· 213, 279
Protection circuit··················································· 262
Index
Contents
Connections
vv R
Random··························································· 66, 111
Rear panel······························································· 21
Rec out function···················································· 136
Remote control unit················································ 24
Inserting the batteries············································ 8
Operating external devices································ 212
Operating learn function····································· 220
Setting the back light········································· 223
Remote lock function············································ 143
Repeat····························································· 66, 111
Resetting factory settings····································· 241
vv S
Sampling frequency·············································· 262
Selecting the input source······································ 60
SiriusXM·································································· 98
Sleep timer···························································· 135
Sound mode·········································· 118, 126, 251
Audyssey DSX®·················································· 124
AUTO································································· 124
DIRECT······················································· 120, 125
Dolby·································································· 122
DTS···································································· 123
Original······························································· 124
PCM multi-channel············································· 123
PURE DIRECT············································ 120, 125
STEREO····························································· 125
Speaker
Connect································································ 32
Install···································································· 29
Set up································································· 183
Speaker impedance·············································· 262
Spotify··································································· 101
Front panel
Display
Playback
Settings
Tips
Sub Display····························································· 19
Surround back speaker····································· 31, 35
Switches light illumination···································· 144
vv T
Tips······································································· 226
Troubleshooting···················································· 228
Tuner operation menu
Auto Preset Memory············································ 76
Direct Tune··························································· 73
Preset Memory···················································· 75
Preset Name························································ 76
Preset Skip··························································· 77
Tune Mode··························································· 73
Turning off the sound temporarily··························· 61
Turning the power on·············································· 60
vv V
Video conversion··················································· 245
Video settings······················································· 172
vTuner····························································· 82, 263
vv W
Web control·························································· 138
Windows Media DRM·········································· 263
Windows Media Player········································· 263
WMA····································································· 263
vv Z
ZONE2/ZONE3········································ 20, 145, 263
Rear panel
271
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
License
nn Expat
This section describes software license used for
this unit. To maintain the correct content, the
original (English) is used.
Expat License. Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai
Open Source Software Center Ltd
nn Boost
http://www.boost.org/
Boost Software License - Version 1.0 - August 17th,
2003
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person or organization obtaining a copy of the software
and accompanying documentation covered by this
license (the “Software”) to use, reproduce, display,
distribute, execute, and transmit the Software, and to
prepare derivative works of the Software, and to permit
third-parties to whom the Software is furnished to do
so, all subject to the following:
The copyright notices in the Software and this entire
statement, including the above license grant, this
restriction and the following disclaimer, must be
included in all copies of the Software, in whole or in
part, and all derivative works of the Software, unless
such copies or derivative works are solely in the form of
machine-executable object code generated by a source
language processor.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE, TITLE AND NON-INFRINGEMENT. IN
NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS
OR ANYONE DISTRIBUTING THE SOFTWARE BE
LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE,
ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH
THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS
IN THE SOFTWARE.
Front panel
Display
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any
person obtaining a copy of this software and associated
documentation files (the “Software”), to deal in
the Software without restriction, including without
limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge,
publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies of
the Software, and to permit persons to whom the
Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following
conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission notice
shall be included in all copies or substantial portions of
the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED,
INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT
SHALL THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS
BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR
IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE
OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
272
Appendix
nn FastDelegate
http://www.jclark.com/xml/expat.html
Rear panel
Tips
Remote
http://www.codeproject.com/KB/cpp/FastDelegate.
aspx
THE WORK (AS DEFINED BELOW) IS PROVIDED
UNDER THE TERMS OF THIS CODE PROJECT OPEN
LICENSE (“LICENSE”). THE WORK IS PROTECTED BY
COPYRIGHT AND/OR OTHER APPLICABLE LAW. ANY
USE OF THE WORK OTHER THAN AS AUTHORIZED
UNDER THIS LICENSE OR COPYRIGHT LAW IS
PROHIBITED.
BY EXERCISING ANY RIGHTS TO THE WORK
PROVIDED HEREIN, YOU ACCEPT AND AGREE TO
BE BOUND BY THE TERMS OF THIS LICENSE. THE
AUTHOR GRANTS YOU THE RIGHTS CONTAINED
HEREIN IN CONSIDERATION OF YOUR ACCEPTANCE
OF SUCH TERMS AND CONDITIONS. IF YOU DO NOT
AGREE TO ACCEPT AND BE BOUND BY THE TERMS
OF THIS LICENSE, YOU CANNOT MAKE ANY USE OF
THE WORK.
1.Definitions.
a.
“Articles” means, collectively, all articles written
by Author which describes how the Source Code
and Executable Files for the Work may be used by a
user.
b.“Author” means the individual or entity that offers
the Work under the terms of this License.
c.“Derivative Work” means a work based upon the
Work or upon the Work and other pre-existing
works.
d.“Executable Files” refer to the executables, binary
files, configuration and any required data files
included in the Work.
e.
“Publisher” means the provider of the website,
magazine, CD-ROM, DVD or other medium from or
by which the Work is obtained by You.
f.“Source Code” refers to the collection of source
code and configuration files used to create the
Executable Files.
Index
Contents
Connections
g.“Standard Version” refers to such a Work if it has not
been modified, or has been modified in accordance
with the consent of the Author, such consent being
in the full discretion of the Author.
h.“Work” refers to the collection of files distributed
by the Publisher, including the Source Code,
Executable Files, binaries, data files, documentation,
whitepapers and the Articles.
i.
“You” is you, an individual or entity wishing to
use the Work and exercise your rights under this
License.
2.Fair Use/Fair Use Rights. Nothing in this License
is intended to reduce, limit, or restrict any rights
arising from fair use, fair dealing, first sale or other
limitations on the exclusive rights of the copyright
owner under copyright law or other applicable laws.
3.License Grant. Subject to the terms and conditions
of this License, the Author hereby grants You a
worldwide, royalty-free, non-exclusive, perpetual
(for the duration of the applicable copyright) license
to exercise the rights in the Work as stated below:
a.You may use the standard version of the Source
Code or Executable Files in Your own applications.
b.You may apply bug fixes, portability fixes and other
modifications obtained from the Public Domain or
from the Author. A Work modified in such a way
shall still be considered the standard version and
will be subject to this License.
c.
You may otherwise modify Your copy of this
Work (excluding the Articles) in any way to create
a Derivative Work, provided that You insert a
prominent notice in each changed file stating how,
when and where You changed that file.
d.
You may distribute the standard version of the
Executable Files and Source Code or Derivative
Work in aggregate with other (possibly commercial)
programs as part of a larger (possibly commercial)
software distribution.
Front panel
Display
Playback
Settings
e.
The Articles discussing the Work published in
any form by the author may not be distributed or
republished without the Author’s consent. The
author retains copyright to any such Articles. You
may use the Executable Files and Source Code
pursuant to this License but you may not repost or
republish or otherwise distribute or make available
the Articles, without the prior written consent of
the Author.
Any subroutines or modules supplied by You and linked
into the Source Code or Executable Files this Work
shall not be considered part of this Work and will not
be subject to the terms of this License.
4.Patent License. Subject to the terms and conditions
of this License, each Author hereby grants to You
a perpetual, worldwide, non-exclusive, no-charge,
royalty-free, irrevocable (except as stated in this
section) patent license to make, have made, use,
import, and otherwise transfer the Work.
5.Restrictions. The license granted in Section 3 above
is expressly made subject to and limited by the
following restrictions:
a.
You agree not to remove any of the original
copyright, patent, trademark, and attribution notices
and associated disclaimers that may appear in the
Source Code or Executable Files.
b.You agree not to advertise or in any way imply that
this Work is a product of Your own.
c.The name of the Author may not be used to endorse
or promote products derived from the Work without
the prior written consent of the Author.
d.You agree not to sell, lease, or rent any part of the
Work. This does not restrict you from including
the Work or any part of the Work inside a larger
software distribution that itself is being sold. The
Work by itself, though, cannot be sold, leased or
rented.
Rear panel
273
Remote
Tips
Appendix
e.You may distribute the Executable Files and Source
Code only under the terms of this License, and You
must include a copy of, or the Uniform Resource
Identifier for, this License with every copy of the
Executable Files or Source Code You distribute
and ensure that anyone receiving such Executable
Files and Source Code agrees that the terms of
this License apply to such Executable Files and/
or Source Code. You may not offer or impose any
terms on the Work that alter or restrict the terms
of this License or the recipients’ exercise of the
rights granted hereunder. You may not sublicense
the Work. You must keep intact all notices that refer
to this License and to the disclaimer of warranties.
You may not distribute the Executable Files or
Source Code with any technological measures
that control access or use of the Work in a manner
inconsistent with the terms of this License.
f.You agree not to use the Work for illegal, immoral or
improper purposes, or on pages containing illegal,
immoral or improper material. The Work is subject
to applicable export laws. You agree to comply with
all such laws and regulations that may apply to the
Work after Your receipt of the Work.
Index
Contents
Connections
6.Representations, Warranties and Disclaimer. THIS
WORK IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, “WHERE IS” AND
“AS AVAILABLE”, WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS
OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS
OR GUARANTEES. YOU, THE USER, ASSUME
ALL RISK IN ITS USE, INCLUDING COPYRIGHT
INFRINGEMENT,
PATENT
INFRINGEMENT,
SUITABILITY,
ETC.
AUTHOR
EXPRESSLY
DISCLAIMS ALL EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR
STATUTORY WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS,
INCLUDING WITHOUT LIMITATION, WARRANTIES
OR CONDITIONS OF MERCHANTABILITY,
MERCHANTABLE QUALITY OR FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE, OR ANY WARRANTY
OF TITLE OR NON-INFRINGEMENT, OR THAT
THE WORK (OR ANY PORTION THEREOF) IS
CORRECT, USEFUL, BUG-FREE OR FREE OF
VIRUSES. YOU MUST PASS THIS DISCLAIMER
ON WHENEVER YOU DISTRIBUTE THE WORK OR
DERIVATIVE WORKS.
7.
Indemnity. You agree to defend, indemnify and
hold harmless the Author and the Publisher from
and against any claims, suits, losses, damages,
liabilities, costs, and expenses (including reasonable
legal or attorneys??? fees) resulting from or relating
to any use of the Work by You.
8.
Limitation on Liability. EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT
REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW, IN NO EVENT
WILL THE AUTHOR OR THE PUBLISHER BE
LIABLE TO YOU ON ANY LEGAL THEORY FOR
ANY SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, CONSEQUENTIAL,
PUNITIVE OR EXEMPLARY DAMAGES ARISING
OUT OF THIS LICENSE OR THE USE OF THE
WORK OR OTHERWISE, EVEN IF THE AUTHOR
OR THE PUBLISHER HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
Front panel
Display
Playback
Settings
9.Termination.
a.This License and the rights granted hereunder will
terminate automatically upon any breach by You
of any term of this License. Individuals or entities
who have received Derivative Works from You under
this License, however, will not have their licenses
terminated provided such individuals or entities
remain in full compliance with those licenses.
Sections 1, 2, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10 and 11 will survive any
termination of this License.
b.If You bring a copyright, trademark, patent or any
other infringement claim against any contributor
over infringements You claim are made by the Work,
your License from such contributor to the Work
ends automatically.
c.
Subject to the above terms and conditions, this
License is perpetual (for the duration of the
applicable copyright in the Work). Notwithstanding
the above, the Author reserves the right to release
the Work under different license terms or to stop
distributing the Work at any time; provided, however
that any such election will not serve to withdraw
this License (or any other license that has been, or
is required to be, granted under the terms of this
License), and this License will continue in full force
and effect unless terminated as stated above.
10.
Publisher. The parties hereby confirm that the
Publisher shall not, under any circumstances,
be responsible for and shall not have any liability
in respect of the subject matter of this License.
The Publisher makes no warranty whatsoever in
connection with the Work and shall not be liable
to You or any party on any legal theory for any
damages whatsoever, including without limitation
any general, special, incidental or consequential
damages arising in connection to this license. The
Publisher reserves the right to cease making the
Work available to You at any time without notice
Rear panel
274
Remote
Tips
Appendix
11.Miscellaneous
a.This License shall be governed by the laws of the
location of the head office of the Author or if the
Author is an individual, the laws of location of the
principal place of residence of the Author.
b.
If any provision of this License is invalid or
unenforceable under applicable law, it shall not
affect the validity or enforceability of the remainder
of the terms of this License, and without further
action by the parties to this License, such provision
shall be reformed to the minimum extent necessary
to make such provision valid and enforceable.
c.
No term or provision of this License shall be
deemed waived and no breach consented to unless
such waiver or consent shall be in writing and
signed by the party to be charged with such waiver
or consent.
d.
This License constitutes the entire agreement
between the parties with respect to the Work
licensed herein. There are no understandings,
agreements or representations with respect to the
Work not specified herein. The Author shall not be
bound by any additional provisions that may appear
in any communication from You. This License
may not be modified without the mutual written
agreement of the Author and You.
nn libogg
http://www.xiph.org/ogg/
Copyright (c) 2002, Xiph.org Foundation
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with
or without modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are met:
•Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
Index
Contents
Connections
•Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and
the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or
other materials provided with the distribution.
•Neither the name of the Xiph.org Foundation nor the
names of its contributors may be used to endorse or
promote products derived from this software without
specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR
PURPOSE
ARE
DISCLAIMED.
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY,
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT
NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
OF SUCH DAMAGE.
nn libvorbis
http://www.xiph.org/vorbis/
Copyright (c) 2002-2004 Xiph.org Foundation
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with
or without modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are met:
Front panel
Display
Playback
Settings
•Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
•Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and
the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or
other materials provided with the distribution.
•Neither the name of the Xiph.org Foundation nor the
names of its contributors may be used to endorse or
promote products derived from this software without
specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR
PURPOSE
ARE
DISCLAIMED.
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY,
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT
NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
OF SUCH DAMAGE.
nn Tremolo
http://wss.co.uk/pinknoise/tremolo
Copyright (C) 2002-2009 Xiph.org Foundation Changes
Copyright (C) 2009-2010 Robin Watts for Pinknoise
Productions Ltd
Rear panel
275
Remote
Tips
Appendix
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with
or without modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are met:
•Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
•Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and
the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or
other materials provided with the distribution.
•Neither the name of the Xiph.org Foundation nor the
names of its contributors may be used to endorse or
promote products derived from this software without
specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR
PURPOSE
ARE
DISCLAIMED.
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY,
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT
NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
OF SUCH DAMAGE.
Index
Contents
Connections
nn Tremor
http://wiki.xiph.org/index.php/Tremor
Copyright (c) 2002, Xiph.org Foundation
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with
or without modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are met:
•Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
•Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and
the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or
other materials provided with the distribution.
•Neither the name of the Xiph.org Foundation nor the
names of its contributors may be used to endorse or
promote products derived from this software without
specific prior written permission.
Playback
Settings
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR
PURPOSE
ARE
DISCLAIMED.
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY,
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT
NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
OF SUCH DAMAGE.
nn Mersenne Twister
http://www.math.sci.hiroshima-u.ac.jp/~m-mat/MT/
MT2002/CODES/mt19937ar.c
Copyright (C) 1997 - 2002, Makoto Matsumoto
and Takuji Nishimura,
All rights reserved.
Tips
2.Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and
the following disclaimer in the documentation and/
or other materials provided with the distribution.
3.
The names of its contributors may not be used
to endorse or promote products derived from this
software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS “AS IS” AND ANY
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN
NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY,
OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT
NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
OF SUCH DAMAGE.
Redistribution and use in source and binary
forms, with or without modification, are
permitted provided that the following conditions
are met:
1.
Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and
the following disclaimer.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
276
Remote
Appendix
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
nn zlib
nn cURL
nn c-ares
zlib.h -- interface of the ‘zlib’ general purpose
compression library version 1.2.3, July 18th, 2005
COPYRIGHT AND PERMISSION NOTICE
Copyright 1998 by the Massachusetts Institute of
Technology.
http://www.zlib.net/
http://curl.haxx.se
Copyright (C) 1995-2004 Jean-loup Gailly and Mark
Adler
This software is provided ‘as-is’, without any express
or implied warranty. In no event will the authors be
held liable for any damages arising from the use of this
software.
Permission is granted to anyone to use this software
for any purpose, including commercial applications,
and to alter it and redistribute it freely, subject to the
following restrictions:
1.
The origin of this software must not be
misrepresented; you must not claim that you wrote
the original software. If you use this software in
a product, an acknowledgment in the product
documentation would be appreciated but is not
required.
2.Altered source versions must be plainly marked as
such, and must not be misrepresented as being the
original software.
3.This notice may not be removed or altered from any
source distribution.
Jean-loup Gailly jloup@gzip.org, Mark Adler madler@
alumni.caltech.edu
Front panel
Display
http://c-ares.haxx.se
Copyright (c) 1996 - 2011, Daniel Stenberg, <daniel@
haxx.se>.
All rights reserved.
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this
software for any purpose with or without fee is hereby
granted, provided that the above copyright notice and
this permission notice appear in all copies.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED “AS IS”, WITHOUT
WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT
OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE
FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT
OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE
OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this
software and its documentation for any purpose and
without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above
copyright notice appear in all copies and that both that
copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
supporting documentation, and that the name of M.I.T.
not be used in advertising or publicity pertaining to
distribution of the software without specific, written
prior permission. M.I.T. makes no representations
about the suitability of this software for any purpose. It
is provided “as is” without express or implied warranty.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a
copyright holder shall not be used in advertising or
otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in
this Software without prior written authorization of the
copyright holder.
Rear panel
277
Remote
Index
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
22License Information for the
Software Used in the Unit
About GPL (GNU-General Public License), LGPL
(GNU Lesser General Public License) License
This product uses GPL/LGPL software and software
made by other companies.
After you purchase this product, you may procure,
modify or distribute the source code of the GPL/
LGPL software that is used in the product.
Marantz provides the source code based on the
GPL and LPGL licenses at the actual cost upon your
request to our customer service center. However,
note that we make no guarantees concerning the
source code. Please also understand that we do not
offer support for the contents of the source code.
Front panel
Display
Rear panel
278
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
List of preset codes
To return a preset code to the default settings, register the AVR code “0000” to the button whose preset code you want to cancel.
AVR
M
Marantz
0000
TV group
Registrable input source button :
A
B
C
Acer
Admiral
Aiko
Aiwa
Akai
Amtron
Anam
Anam National
AOC
Audiovox
Bell & Howell
Benq
Broksonic
Celebrity
Citizen
Colortyme
Contec/Cony
Craig
Crown
Curtis Mathes
Front panel
1141
1009, 1089, 1002
1059
1117, 1118
1001
1023
1113
1023, 1069, 1092
1003, 1049, 1024, 1127
1023
1009, 1025
1104, 1142
1097, 1098, 1113, 1003
1001
1003, 1023, 1059, 1063, 1026, 1013
1003, 1043
1045, 1047, 1023, 1113
1023, 1113, 1020, 1022
1023, 1067
1003, 1110, 1025, 1062, 1026, 1103,
1013
Display
D
E
Daewoo
Daytron
Dimensia
Dumont
Electroband
Electrohome
Emerson
F
G
Envision
Fisher
Fujitsu
Funai
Gateway
GE
Goldstar
H
Hallmark
Hisense
Rear panel
1003, 1059, 1024, 1084, 1101, 1013,
1035, 1036
1003, 1013, 1016
1110, 1103
1010, 1003, 1153
1001
1003, 1133, 1001, 1069
1003, 1020, 1044, 1038, 1045, 1048,
1055, 1023, 1025, 1061, 1022, 1094,
1096, 1099, 1013, 1113, 1101, 1015,
1021
1003
1051, 1025, 1091, 1160
1038, 1124, 1125, 1155
1038, 1023, 1113
1150
1110, 1003, 1085, 1046, 1054, 1133,
1018, 1069, 1022, 1103, 1113, 1136,
1153
1045, 1024, 1112, 1080, 1100, 1013,
1003, 1030, 1154
1003
1116
279
Remote
Hitachi
I
J
Infinity
Janeil
JBL
JC Penney
Jensen
JVC
K
Kawasho
Kenwood
Kloss Novabeam
KTV
L
M
LG
M.Wards
Magnavox
Marantz
Mitsubishi
Motorola
Index
1003, 1012, 1031, 1032, 1037, 1041,
1045, 1047, 1065, 1068, 1082, 1088,
1094, 1139, 1140, 1145, 1159
1067
1134
1067
1003, 1046, 1047, 1054, 1133, 1110,
1019, 1112, 1024, 1063, 1018, 1026,
1083, 1085, 1100, 1103, 1013, 1154
1003
1045, 1047, 1050, 1060, 1065, 1028,
1029
1003, 1001
1003
1056, 1023, 1057, 1134
1023, 1073, 1099, 1013, 1113, 1033,
1034
1024, 1030
1002, 1009, 1038
1003, 1052, 1053, 1056, 1057, 1063,
1081, 1067, 1106
1000, 1003, 1122, 1067, 1031
1003, 1051, 1133, 1122, 1024, 1115
1069, 1014
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
TV group
Registrable input source button :
N
O
P
NEC
NET-TV
Orion
Panasonic
Philips
Philips Magnavox
Pioneer
Plasmsync
Portland
Price Club
Prism
Proscan
Q
R
Proton
Quasar
Radio Shack
Radio Shack/
Realistic
RCA
S
Realistic
Runco
Sampo
Sampo
Samsung
Sansui
Front panel
1003, 1043, 1024, 1069, 1012
1137, 1150
1020, 1096
1017, 1067, 1069, 1111, 1095
1003, 1045, 1052, 1054, 1056, 1057,
1058, 1063, 1069, 1067, 1011
1106, 1067
1003, 1018, 1070, 1071, 1037, 1094,
1145, 1147, 1149
1135
1003, 1059, 1024, 1013
1026
1018
1110, 1085, 1103, 1004, 1005, 1006,
1007, 1008
1003, 1045
1069, 1073, 1111, 1010, 1153
1025, 1103, 1113, 1024
1003, 1045, 1023, 1110, 1025, 1015,
1100, 1013
1110, 1003, 1049, 1024, 1069, 1075,
1079, 1085, 1087, 1088, 1093, 1094,
1101, 1103, 1085, 1113, 1004, 1005,
1006, 1007, 1008, 1153, 1014
1025, 1103
1010, 1153
1150
1150
1003, 1045, 1024, 1062, 1026, 1078,
1083, 1090, 1100, 1013, 1105, 1040,
1114, 1157, 1120, 1121, 1148, 1146
1119
Display
Sanyo
Sharp
Signature
Sony
Soundesign
Starlite
Supre-Macy
Sylvania
T
Symphonic
Tandy
Tatung
Technics
Techwood
Teknika
Telecaption
Toshiba
U
V
Totevision
Universal
Video Concepts
Viewsonic
W
Wards
White
Westinghouse
Rear panel
1003, 1051, 1025, 1072, 1077, 1091,
1156, 1157, 1158
1003, 1045, 1055, 1015, 1064, 1066,
1076, 1089, 1013, 1014, 1123
1009
1001, 1102, 1108
1003, 1038, 1023, 1063, 1113
1023
1134
1003, 1042, 1052, 1053, 1063, 1056,
1057, 1067, 1089, 1151, 1039
1044, 1023, 1039
1014
1069
1018
1003, 1018
1003, 1009, 1038, 1045, 1047, 1063,
1023, 1059, 1024, 1063, 1026, 1111,
1013, 1113
1074
1042, 1025, 1074, 1026, 1098, 1003,
1107, 1019, 1136, 1111, 1135
1013
1046, 1054
1113
1130, 1128, 1006, 1131, 1129, 1109,
1143, 1150, 1022, 1145, 1138
1003, 1009, 1044, 1038, 1046, 1052,
1054, 1056, 1110, 1057, 1024, 1015,
1067, 1086, 1103
Y
Z
Yamaha
Zenith
1101, 1001
280
Remote
Index
1003, 1024
1132, 1010, 1003, 1009, 1144, 1153
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
DVD group
Registrable input source button :
A
B
D
F
G
H
J
K
M
O
P
R
S
Aiwa
Apex
Bluray
BOSE
Denon
Funai
GE
Harman Kardon
Hitachi
JVC
Kenwood
Koss
Magnavox
Marantz
Mitsubishi
Onkyo
Oritron
Panasonic
Philips
Pioneer
Proscan
RCA
Sampo
Samsung
Sanyo
Sharp
Sherwood
Sony
Front panel
2036, 2037
2017, 2034, 2018, 2019, 2021, 2012
2064
2038, 2039, 2063
2047, 2048
2049
2020, 2029, 2033, 2009
2061
2031, 2012, 2008
2006, 2010, 2040, 2041, 2042, 2043
2054, 2053
2058
2023, 2025, 2011, 2007
2000, 2025, 2065
2011, 2015
2062
2030, 2009
2003, 2015, 2016, 2055
2007, 2011, 2058
2002, 2014, 2056
2020, 2032, 2009
2020, 2005, 2009, 2035, 2057
2041
2008, 2022, 2024, 2027, 2012
2050, 2052
2044, 2045
2051
2001, 2013, 2059
Display
T
Y
Z
Toshiba
Yamaha
Zenith
Rear panel
2004, 2026, 2028, 2008
2046, 2060
2010
281
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Appendix
CD group
Registrable input source button :
A
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
K
L
M
AIWA
AKAI
AUDIO
AUDIO LABS
CALIFORNIA
CARVER
CASIO
CURTIS
Denon
EMERSON
FISHER
GE
GENEXXA
HARMON
HITACHI
INKEL
JC PENNEY
JVC
KARDON
KENWOOD
KRELL
LUXMAN
LX I
MAGNAVOX
Marantz
MATHES
MCS
MGA
Front panel
3001, 3002, 3003
3004, 3005, 3006
3007
3008
3008
3010, 3011, 3009
3012, 3020
3020, 3012
3013
3014
3011, 3015, 3016, 3017, 3018
3019
3014, 3021, 3020
3022, 3023, 3051
3020
3024
3012, 3020, 3025
3026, 3027
3022, 3051, 3023
3028, 3029, 3030, 3031, 3032, 3033
3010
3035, 3036, 3037, 3038
3012, 3020, 3014
3010, 3039, 3040
3000, 3010, 3041, 3042, 3043
3012, 3020
3012, 3020
3023
Display
N
O
MISSION
MITSUBISHI
NAD
NAKAMICHI
NEC MCS
NIKKO
ONKYO
OPTIMUS
P
Q
R
S
PANASONIC
PHILIPS
PIONEER
QUASAR
RCA
REALISTIC
ROTEL
RS ORIGINAL
SAE
SAMSUNG
SANSUI
SANYO
SCOTT
SEARS
SHARP
SHERWOOD
SHURE
SONY
Rear panel
3010
3023, 3044
3034, 3045
3046, 3047, 3048
3025
3007, 3016
3049, 3050, 3051, 3052, 3055, 3102,
3103
3011, 3014, 3020, 3028, 3053, 3054,
3056, 3057, 3058, 3059
3008, 3060, 3061
3009, 3010, 3010, 3040
3020, 3021, 3062, 3063, 3064
3008
3011, 3014, 3065, 3066, 3067, 3068,
3069
3011, 3014, 3020, 3042, 3054, 3057
3010
3070
3010, 3083
3071
3014, 3068, 3072, 3073
3011, 3018, 3074, 3075, 3076
3014
3012, 3014, 3020, 3028, 3042
3028, 3042, 3077
3042, 3056, 3070, 3078, 3024
3025
3039, 3079, 3080, 3081, 3082, 3097,
3098, 3099, 3100, 3101
282
Remote
SYLVANIA
SYMPHONIC
T
TEAC
V
Y
Z
TECHNICA
THETA DIGITAL
TOSHIBA
VICTOR
YAMAHA
ZENITH
Index
3010
3083
3016, 3042, 3057, 3083, 3084, 3085,
3086
3007, 3008, 3061, 3087, 3088
3040
3045
3026
3007, 3089, 3090, 3091, 3092
3016, 3093, 3094, 3095, 3096
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Appendix
Tips
CBL/SAT group
Registrable input source button :
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
J
L
M
N
Alphastar
Amstrad
Apple TV
Atsky
BSkyB
Chaparral
Direct Tv
DISH Network
Drake
4027
4046, 4047, 4050
4068
4048
4021, 4045, 4046
4039
4001, 4016, 4044
4030
4026
4007, 4017, 4018, 4019, 4020, 4062,
Echostar
4063, 4064
Eurosky
4056, 4047
Express Vu
4017
Foxtel
4051
Freesat
4056
Fujitsu
4025
GE
4002, 4008, 4009
General Instruments 4036, 4037
Gradiente
4044, 4057
Hitachi
4001, 4015
Hughes Network
4001, 4016
Humax
4049, 4050, 4051, 4052, 4053
Janeil
4025
JVC
4017
LG Smart TV
4069
Marantz
4000
Mitsubishi
4001
NETGEAR Neo TV 4072
Front panel
Display
O
P
R
S
Nokia
Optima
Panasonic
Philips
Proscan
Radio Shack
RCA
Realistic
Roku XDS
Rural Cable
Samsung
Schneider
SKY
Skyplus
Skysat
Sony
T
U
V
Star Choice
Star Trak
STS
SuperDish
Teac
Thomson
Toshiba
Universum
Uniden
Video Pall
Rear panel
4058, 4059, 4060, 4061
4048
4004, 4010
4031, 4044, 4057, 4035
4002, 4008, 4009, 4011
4036, 4037
4002, 4008, 4009, 4029
4040
4073
4036
4022, 4027, 4042, 4043, 4054, 4055,
4050
4041, 4043
4044, 4045, 4057
4048
4041, 4047, 4056
4003, 4012, 4014, 4065, 4066, 4067,
4070
4032
4024
4038
4028
4049
4046, 4056
4001, 4034
4056
4005, 4006, 4013
4025
283
Remote
W
Z
Western Digital
WD TV
Zenith
Index
4071
4033, 4025, 4023
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
Blu-ray group
Registrable input source button :
D
H
I
J
L
M
O
P
R
S
T
Y
Denon
Hitachi
Integra
JVC
LG
Marantz
Mitsubishi
Onkyo
Panasonic
Philips
Pioneer
RCA
Samsung
Sharp
Sony
Toshiba
Yamaha
Front panel
5034, 5035, 5036
5031, 5032, 5033
5013
5014, 5015, 5017, 5018, 5019, 5020
5010, 5011
5000, 5026, 5027
5024, 5025
5013
5001, 5002, 5003
5004
5005
5012
5005
5028, 5029, 5030
5007, 5008, 5009, 5016
5012
5021, 5022, 5023
Display
Rear panel
284
Remote
Index
Appendix
Contents
Connections
Playback
Settings
Tips
55/64
(22)
22Dimensions
Appendix
2 13/64
(56)
22Weight : 29 lbs 16 oz (13.6 kg)
Front panel
Display
1 31/32
(50)
Rear panel
1 31/32
(50)
13 25/64 (340)
285
19/32
(15)
6 11/16 (170)
17 21/64 (440)
7 9/32 (185)
45/64
(18)
10 33/64 (267)
2 11/64
(55)
15 25/32 (401)
14 7/32 (361)
1 17/32
(39)
Unit : in. (mm)
Remote
Index
D&M Holdings Inc.
3520 10237 00AM